blob: e37f84cf6b05beb43ae260a7603a522529cf10e1 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau080347f2021-05-01 08:25:15 +02007 2021/05/01
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
340over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 501 when haproxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
615quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500693Remember that backslahes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
699When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
700double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
701and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
702a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
703a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
704the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
705regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
706around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
707more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200708
709
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007102.3. Environment variables
711--------------------------
712
713HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
714interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
715configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
716optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
717shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200718underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
719list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
720arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
721before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200722
723 Example:
724
725 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
726
727 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
728
729 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
730
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200731Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
732file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200733
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200734* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
735 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
736
737* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
738 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
739 directory.
740
741* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
742
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500743* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200744 processes, separated by semicolons.
745
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500746* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200747 CLI, separated by semicolons.
748
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200749In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
750regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
751only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
752
753* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
754
755* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
756 starting at one.
757
758* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
759 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
760 first section.
761
762These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
763if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
764section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
765"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
766proxies.
767
768This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
769logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
770to name some config objects like servers for example.
771
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200772See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200773
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100774
7752.4. Conditional blocks
776-----------------------
777
778It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
779some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
780ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
781configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
782versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
783preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
784text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
785lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
786switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
787are defined to form conditional blocks:
788
789 - .if <condition>
790 - .elif <condition>
791 - .else
792 - .endif
793
794The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
795as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
796matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
797there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
798only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
799".elif" of a block.
800
801Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
802ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
803as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
804
805The conditions are currently limited to:
806
807 - an empty string, always returns "false"
808 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
809 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200810 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
811
812The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
813
814 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
815 exists, regardless of its contents
816
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200817 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
818 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
819 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
820
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200821 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
822 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
823
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200824 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
825 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
826 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
827 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
828
829 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
830 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
831 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
832 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
833
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200834Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100835
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200836 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
837 listen mwcli_px
838 bind :1111
839 ...
840 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100841
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200842 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
843 bind :80
844 .endif
845
846 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200847 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200848 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200849 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200850 .endif
851
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200852 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
853 profiling.memory on
854 .endif
855
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200856Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100857
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200858 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100859 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
860 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
861 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
862
863Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
864"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
865fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
866provide advice to the user.
867
868Example:
869
870 .if "${A}"
871 .if "${B}"
872 .notice "A=1, B=1"
873 .elif "${C}"
874 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
875 .elif "${D}"
876 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
877 .else
878 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
879 .endif
880 .else
881 .notice "A=0"
882 .endif
883
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200884 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
885 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
886
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100887
8882.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200889----------------
890
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100891Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100892values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
893otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
894numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
895for every keyword. Supported units are :
896
897 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
898 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
899 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
900 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
901 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
902 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
903
904
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009052.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200906-------------
907
908 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
909 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
910 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
911 global
912 daemon
913 maxconn 256
914
915 defaults
916 mode http
917 timeout connect 5000ms
918 timeout client 50000ms
919 timeout server 50000ms
920
921 frontend http-in
922 bind *:80
923 default_backend servers
924
925 backend servers
926 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
927
928
929 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
930 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
931 global
932 daemon
933 maxconn 256
934
935 defaults
936 mode http
937 timeout connect 5000ms
938 timeout client 50000ms
939 timeout server 50000ms
940
941 listen http-in
942 bind *:80
943 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
944
945
946Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
947
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100948 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200949
950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009513. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952--------------------
953
954Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
955are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
956of them have command-line equivalents.
957
958The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
959
960 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200961 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200962 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200963 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200964 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200966 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200967 - description
968 - deviceatlas-json-file
969 - deviceatlas-log-level
970 - deviceatlas-separator
971 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900972 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200973 - gid
974 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100975 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200976 - h1-case-adjust
977 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100978 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100979 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100980 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200981 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200982 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200983 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100984 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200985 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100986 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100987 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200988 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200989 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200990 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200991 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +0100992 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200993 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200994 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100995 - presetenv
996 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200997 - uid
998 - ulimit-n
999 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001000 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001001 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001002 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001003 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001004 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001005 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001006 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001007 - ssl-default-bind-options
1008 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001009 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001010 - ssl-default-server-options
1011 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001012 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001013 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001014 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001015 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001016 - 51degrees-data-file
1017 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001018 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001019 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001020 - wurfl-data-file
1021 - wurfl-information-list
1022 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001023 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001024 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001025
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001026 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001027 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001028 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001029 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001030 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001031 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001032 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001033 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001034 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001035 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001036 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001037 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001038 - noepoll
1039 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001040 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001041 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001042 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001043 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001044 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001045 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001046 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001047 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001048 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001049 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001050 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001051 - tune.buffers.limit
1052 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001053 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001054 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001055 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001056 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001057 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001058 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001059 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001060 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001061 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001062 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001063 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001064 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001065 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001066 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001067 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1068 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001069 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001070 - tune.maxaccept
1071 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001072 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001073 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001074 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001075 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1076 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001077 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1078 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001079 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001080 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001081 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001082 - tune.sndbuf.client
1083 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001084 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001085 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001086 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001087 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001088 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001089 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001090 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001091 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001092 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001093 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001094 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1095 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1096 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001097 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1098 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001099
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001100 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001101 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001102 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001103
1104
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011053.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001106------------------------------------
1107
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001108ca-base <dir>
1109 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001110 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1111 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1112 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001113
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001114chroot <jail dir>
1115 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1116 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1117 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1118 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1119 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001120 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001121
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001122cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1123 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1124 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1125 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1126 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1127 set. These sets have the format
1128
1129 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1130
1131 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001132 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001133 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1134 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001135 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1136 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001137 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1138 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1139 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1140 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1141 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1142 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1143 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1144 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1145 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1146 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001147
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001148 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1149 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1150 on the machine's word size.
1151
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001152 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001153 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1154 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1155 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1156 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1157 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1158 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001159
1160 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001161 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1162
1163 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1164 # first 4 CPUs
1165
1166 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1167 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1168 # word size.
1169
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001170 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001171 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001172 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1173 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1174 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1175
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001176 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1177 # and so on.
1178 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1179 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1180 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1181
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001182 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001183 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1184 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1185 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1186
1187 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1188 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1189 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1190
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001191 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1192 # and a thread range.
1193 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1194 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1195 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1196
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001197crt-base <dir>
1198 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001199 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1200 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001201
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001202daemon
1203 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1204 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001205 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1206 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001207
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001208default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
1209 By default haproxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
1210 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1211 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1212 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1213 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1214 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1215 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1216 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1217 not start with a slash ('/'):
1218 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1219 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1220
1221 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1222 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1223 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1224 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1225 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1226 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1227 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1228 each of them.
1229
1230 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1231 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1232 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1233 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1234 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1235 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1236 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1237 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1238
1239 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1240 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
1241 different haproxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
1242 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1243 made easily relocatable.
1244
1245 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1246 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1247 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1248 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1249 consistent across all configuration files.
1250
1251 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1252 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1253 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1254 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1255 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1256 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1257 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1258 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1259
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001260deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1261 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001262 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001263
1264deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001265 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001266 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1267
1268deviceatlas-separator <char>
1269 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1270 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1271
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001272deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001273 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1274 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1275 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001276
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001277external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001278 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1279 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001280 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1281 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1282 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1283 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1284 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001285
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001286gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001287 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001288 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1289 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001290 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1291 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001292 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001293
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001294group <group name>
1295 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1296 See also "gid" and "user".
1297
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001298hard-stop-after <time>
1299 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1300
1301 Arguments :
1302 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1303 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1304 SIGUSR1 signal.
1305
1306 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1307 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1308 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1309
1310 Example:
1311 global
1312 hard-stop-after 30s
1313
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001314h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1315 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1316 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1317 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1318 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001319 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001320 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1321 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1322 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1323 specified in a proxy.
1324
1325 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1326 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1327 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1328 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1329 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1330 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1331 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1332
1333 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1334 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1335 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1336 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1337 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1338
1339 Example:
1340 global
1341 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1342
1343 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1344 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1345
1346h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1347 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1348 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1349 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1350 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1351 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1352 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1353 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1354 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1355
1356 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1357 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1358 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1359
1360 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1361 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1362
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001363insecure-fork-wanted
1364 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1365 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1366 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1367 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1368 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1369 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1370 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1371 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1372 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1373 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1374 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1375 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1376 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1377 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1378 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1379 disable it.
1380
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001381insecure-setuid-wanted
1382 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1383 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1384 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1385 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1386 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1387 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1388 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1389 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1390 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1391 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1392 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1393 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1394 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1395 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1396
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001397issuers-chain-path <dir>
1398 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1399 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1400 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1401 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1402 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1403 "issuers-chain-path".
1404 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1405 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1406 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1407 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1408 will share the chain in memory.
1409
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001410localpeer <name>
1411 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1412 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1413 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1414 the configuration parsing.
1415
1416 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1417 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1418
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001419log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001420 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001421 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001422 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001423 configured with "log global".
1424
1425 <address> can be one of:
1426
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001427 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001428 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1429 port).
1430
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001431 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1432 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1433 port).
1434
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001435 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001436 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1437 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001438 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001439
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001440 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1441 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1442 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1443 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1444 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1445 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1446 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1447 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1448 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1449 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1450 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1451 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1452 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1453 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001454 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1455 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001456
1457 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1458 "fd@2", see above.
1459
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001460 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1461 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1462 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1463 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1464 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1465
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001466 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1467 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001468
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001469 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1470 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1471 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1472 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1473 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1474 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1475 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1476 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1477 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1478 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001479 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1480 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001481
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001482 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1483 one of the following :
1484
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001485 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1486 field is stripped. This is the default.
1487 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1488 rfc3164.
1489
1490 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001491 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1492
1493 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1494 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1495
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001496 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1497 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1498 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1499 designed to be used with a local log server.
1500
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001501 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1502 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1503 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1504 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1505 logger consumes.
1506
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001507 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1508 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1509 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1510 used with a local log server.
1511
1512 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1513 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1514 designed to be used with a local log server.
1515
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001516 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1517 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1518 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1519 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1520
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001521 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1522 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1523 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1524 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1525 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1526
1527 <sample_size>
1528 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1529 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1530 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1531 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1532 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1533
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001534 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001535
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001536 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1537 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1538 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1539
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001540 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1541 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1542 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1543 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001544
1545 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001546 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1547 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1548 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1549 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1550 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1551 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001552
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001553 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001554
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001555log-send-hostname [<string>]
1556 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1557 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1558 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1559 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1560 the logs.
1561
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001562log-tag <string>
1563 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1564 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1565 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001566 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001567
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001568lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001569 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1570 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1571 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1572 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1573 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1574 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001575 used multiple times.
1576
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001577lua-load-per-thread <file>
1578 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1579 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1580 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1581 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1582 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1583 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1584 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1585 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1586 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1587 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1588 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1589 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1590 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1591 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1592 times.
1593
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001594lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1595 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1596 variable.
1597 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1598 to "path".
1599
1600 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1601 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1602 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1603 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1604 will be checked earlier.
1605
1606 As an example by specifying the following path:
1607
1608 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1609 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1610
1611 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1612 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1613 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1614 paths if that does not exist either.
1615
1616 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1617 documentation.
1618
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001619master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001620 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1621 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1622 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001623 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001624 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1625 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001626 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1627 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1628 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1629 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1630 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001631
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001632 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001633
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001634mworker-max-reloads <number>
1635 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001636 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001637 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1638 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1639 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1640
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001641nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001642 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1643 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1644 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001645 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1646 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001647 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1648 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1649 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001650
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001651nbthread <number>
1652 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001653 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1654 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1655 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1656 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1657 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001658 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1659 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1660 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1661 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1662 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1663 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1664 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001665
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001666numa-cpu-mapping
1667 By default, if running on Linux, haproxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
1668 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1669 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1670 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1671 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1672 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1673 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1674 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1675 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1676
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001677pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001678 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1679 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1680 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1681 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001682
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001683pp2-never-send-local
1684 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1685 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1686 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1687 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1688 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1689 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1690 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1691 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1692 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1693 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1694 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1695
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001696presetenv <name> <value>
1697 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1698 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1699 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1700 and "unsetenv".
1701
1702resetenv [<name> ...]
1703 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1704 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1705 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1706 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1707 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1708 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1709 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1710 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1711
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001712stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001713 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1714 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1715 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1716 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1717 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1718 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001719 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001720 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1721 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1722 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1723 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001724
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001725server-state-base <directory>
1726 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001727 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1728 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001729
1730server-state-file <file>
1731 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1732 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1733 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1734 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1735 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1736 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1737 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1738 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001739 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1740 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001741
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001742set-var <var-name> <expr>
1743 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1744 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1745 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1746 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1747 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1748 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1749 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1750 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1751 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1752
1753 Example:
1754 global
1755 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1756 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1757 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1758
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001759setenv <name> <value>
1760 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1761 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1762 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1763 and "unsetenv".
1764
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001765set-dumpable
1766 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001767 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1768 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1769 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1770 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1771 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1772 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1773 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1774 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1775 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1776 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1777 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1778 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1779 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1780 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1781 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1782 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1783 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001784
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001785ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1786 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1787 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001788 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001789 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001790 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1791 information and recommendations see e.g.
1792 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1793 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1794 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1795 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001796
1797ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1798 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1799 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1800 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1801 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1802 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001803 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1804 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1805 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001806 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001807
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001808ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1809 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1810 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1811 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1812 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1813 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1814
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001815ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1816 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1817 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1818 keyword to see available options.
1819
1820 Example:
1821 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001822 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001823
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001824ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1825 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1826 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001827 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001828 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001829 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1830 information and recommendations see e.g.
1831 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1832 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1833 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1834 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1835 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001836
1837ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1838 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1839 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1840 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1841 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1842 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001843 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1844 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1845 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1846 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001847
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001848ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1849 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1850 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1851 keyword to see available options.
1852
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001853ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1854 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1855 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1856 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001857 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001858 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001859 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1860 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1861 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1862 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001863 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1864 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1865 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1866
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001867ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1868 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1869 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001870 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001871 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001872 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1873
1874 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001875
1876 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1877 and won't try to remove them.
1878
1879 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1880
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001881ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001882 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001883 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1884 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001885
1886 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1887 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1888 optimize the startup time.
1889
1890 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1891 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1892 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1893
1894 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001895 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001896
1897 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001898 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1899
1900 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1901 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1902 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1903 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1904 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1905 bind configuration..
1906
1907 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1908 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1909 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1910 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1911 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1912 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1913 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1914 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1915
1916 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1917
1918 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1919 a cert bundle.
1920
1921 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1922 separately in several "crt".
1923
1924 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1925 since files are loading separately.
1926
1927 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1928 required to commit them.
1929
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001930 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001931 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001932
1933 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1934
1935 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1936
1937 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1938 not provided in the PEM file.
1939
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001940 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1941 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1942
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001943 The default behavior is "all".
1944
1945 Example:
1946 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1947 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1948 ssl-load-extra-files none
1949
1950 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1951
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001952ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1953 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1954 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1955 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1956
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001957ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001958 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001959 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1960 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1961 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1962 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1963 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1964 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001965 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001966
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001967stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1968 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1969 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1970 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001971 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001972 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001973
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001974 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1975 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1976 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001977
1978stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1979 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1980 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001981 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001982
1983stats maxconn <connections>
1984 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1985 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1986
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001987uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001988 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001989 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1990 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1991 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1992
1993ulimit-n <number>
1994 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1995 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1996 option.
1997
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001998unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1999 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2000
2001 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2002 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2003 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2004 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2005 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
2006 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
2007 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2008 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2009 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2010 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2011
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002012unsetenv [<name> ...]
2013 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2014 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2015 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2016 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2017 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2018 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2019 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2020
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002021user <user name>
2022 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2023 See also "uid" and "group".
2024
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002025node <name>
2026 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2027
2028 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2029 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2030 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2031 traffic.
2032
2033description <text>
2034 Add a text that describes the instance.
2035
2036 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2037 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2038 "<" and ">" characters.
2039
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100204051degrees-data-file <file path>
2041 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002042 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002043
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002044 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002045 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2046
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000204751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002048 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2049 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2050 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2051
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002052 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002053 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2054
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200205551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002056 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2057 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2058
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002059 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
2060 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2061
206251degrees-cache-size <number>
2063 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2064 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2065 By default, this cache is disabled.
2066
2067 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002068 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2069
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002070wurfl-data-file <file path>
2071 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2072 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2073
2074 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2075 with USE_WURFL=1.
2076
2077wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2078 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2079 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2080 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2081
2082 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2083
2084 Valid WURFL properties are:
2085 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2086
2087 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2088 device.
2089
2090 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2091 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2092
2093 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2094 particular web request.
2095
2096 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2097 used Libwurfl API version.
2098
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002099 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2100 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2101
2102 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2103 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2104
2105 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2106
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002107 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2108 with USE_WURFL=1.
2109
2110wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2111 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2112 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2113
2114 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2115 with USE_WURFL=1.
2116
2117wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2118 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2119 thus before the chroot.
2120
2121 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2122 with USE_WURFL=1.
2123
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002124wurfl-cache-size <size>
2125 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2126 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002127 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002128 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002129
2130 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2131 with USE_WURFL=1.
2132
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002133strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002134 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
2135 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2136 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2137 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2138 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021403.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002141-----------------------
2142
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002143busy-polling
2144 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2145 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2146 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2147 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2148 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2149 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2150 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2151 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2152 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2153 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2154 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2155 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2156 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2157 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2158 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2159 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2160 "poll" pollers.
2161
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002162 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2163 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2164 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2165
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002166max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
2167 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
2168 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2169 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2170 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2171 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2172 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2173 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2174 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2175
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002176maxconn <number>
2177 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2178 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2179 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002180 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2181 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2182 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2183 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002184 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2185 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2186 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2187 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2188 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2189 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002190
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002191maxconnrate <number>
2192 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2193 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2194 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2195 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2196 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2197 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2198 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2199 fairness.
2200
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002201maxcomprate <number>
2202 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002203 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002204 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2205 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2206 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002207 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002208 default value.
2209
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002210maxcompcpuusage <number>
2211 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2212 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2213 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2214 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
2215 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2216 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2217 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2218 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2219
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002220maxpipes <number>
2221 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2222 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2223 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2224 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2225 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2226 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2227
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002228maxsessrate <number>
2229 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2230 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2231 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2232 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2233 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2234 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2235 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2236 fairness.
2237
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002238maxsslconn <number>
2239 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2240 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2241 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2242 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2243 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2244 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2245 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002246 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2247 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2248 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2249 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
2250 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
2251 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2252 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002253
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002254maxsslrate <number>
2255 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2256 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2257 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2258 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2259 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2260 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2261 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2262 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2263 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2264 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2265
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002266maxzlibmem <number>
2267 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2268 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2269 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002270 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2271 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2272 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2273
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002274noepoll
2275 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2276 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002277 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002278
2279nokqueue
2280 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2281 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2282 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2283
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002284noevports
2285 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2286 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2287 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2288 also "nopoll".
2289
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002290nopoll
2291 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2292 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002293 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002294 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2295 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002296
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002297nosplice
2298 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002299 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002300 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002301 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002302 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2303 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2304 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2305 "option splice-response".
2306
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002307nogetaddrinfo
2308 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2309 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2310
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002311noreuseport
2312 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2313 command line argument "-dR".
2314
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002315profiling.memory { on | off }
2316 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2317 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2318 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2319 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2320 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2321 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2322 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2323 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2324 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2325
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002326profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2327 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2328 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2329 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2330 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002331 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002332 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2333 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2334 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2335 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2336
2337 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2338 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2339 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2340 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2341 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002342 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2343 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2344 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2345 CLI.
2346
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002347spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002348 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2349 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2350 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2351 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2352 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2353 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002354
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002355ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002356 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002357 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002358 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2359 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2360 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2361 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2362 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002363 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2364 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002365 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2366 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2367 openssl configuration file uses:
2368 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2369
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002370ssl-mode-async
2371 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002372 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002373 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2374 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2375 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002376 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002377 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002378
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002379tune.buffers.limit <number>
2380 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2381 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2382 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2383 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2384 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002385 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002386 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2387 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2388 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2389 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2390 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2391 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2392 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2393 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2394 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2395
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002396tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2397 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2398 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2399 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2400 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2401
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002402tune.bufsize <number>
2403 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2404 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2405 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2406 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2407 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2408 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2409 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002410 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2411 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2412 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002413 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002414 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2415 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2416 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002417
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002418tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2419 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002420
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002421tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2422 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2423 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2424 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2425 this value. The default value is 1.
2426
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002427tune.fail-alloc
2428 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2429 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2430 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2431 gracefully.
2432
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002433tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2434 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2435 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2436 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2437 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2438 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2439
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002440tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2441 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2442 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2443 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2444 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2445 change it.
2446
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002447tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2448 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002449 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2450 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002451 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2452 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2453 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2454 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2455 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2456
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002457tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2458 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2459 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2460 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2461 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2462 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2463 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2464 recommended not to change this value.
2465
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002466tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2467 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2468 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2469 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2470 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2471 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2472 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2473 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2474
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002475tune.http.cookielen <number>
2476 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2477 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2478 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2479 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2480 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2481 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2482 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2483 to change this value.
2484
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002485tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002486 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2487 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002488 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002489 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002490 configuration directives too.
2491 The default value is 1024.
2492
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002493tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2494 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2495 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2496 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2497 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2498 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2499 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002500 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2501 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2502 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002503
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002504tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2505 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2506 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2507 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2508 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2509 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2510 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002511 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2512 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2513 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2514 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2515 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002516
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002517tune.idletimer <timeout>
2518 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2519 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2520 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2521 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2522 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2523 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002524 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002525 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002526 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2527
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002528tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2529 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2530 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2531 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2532 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2533 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2534 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2535 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2536 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2537 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2538
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002539tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2540 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002541 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002542 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2543 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002544 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002545 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2546 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2547
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002548tune.lua.maxmem
2549 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2550 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2551 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2552 memory.
2553
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002554tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2555 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002556 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2557 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002558 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002559
2560tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2561 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2562 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2563 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2564 check servers.
2565
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002566tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2567 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2568 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2569 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002570 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002571
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002572tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002573 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2574 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002575 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2576 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2577 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2578 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2579 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2580 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2581 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2582 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2583 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002584
2585tune.maxpollevents <number>
2586 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2587 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2588 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2589 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2590 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2591
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002592tune.maxrewrite <number>
2593 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2594 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2595 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2596 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2597 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2598 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2599 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2600 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2601 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2602 bufsize.
2603
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002604tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2605 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2606 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2607 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2608 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2609 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2610 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2611 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2612 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2613 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002614 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2615 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002616 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2617 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2618 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2619 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2620 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2621 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2622 setting this parameter to 0.
2623
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002624tune.pipesize <number>
2625 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2626 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2627 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2628 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2629 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2630 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2631
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002632tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2633 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2634 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2635 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2636 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2637 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2638 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002639 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002640
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002641tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2642 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2643 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2644 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2645 default is 20.
2646
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002647tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2648tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2649 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2650 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2651 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002652 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002653 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002654 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2655 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2656
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002657tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002658 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002659 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2660 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2661 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2662 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2663
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002664tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002665 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002666 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2667 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2668 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2669 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2670 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2671 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2672 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002673
2674tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2675 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2676 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2677 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2678 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2679 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2680 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2681 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2682 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2683 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002684
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002685tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2686tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2687 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2688 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2689 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002690 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002691 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002692 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2693 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2694 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2695 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2696 notifying haproxy again.
2697
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002698tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002699 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002700 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2701 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2702 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2703 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2704 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2705 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2706 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2707 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2708 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2709 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2710 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002711
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002712tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002713 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002714 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2715 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2716 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2717 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2718 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2719
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002720tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2721 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2722 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2723 performances. This is disabled by default.
2724
2725 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2726 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2727
2728 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2729
2730 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2731
2732 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2733
2734 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2735 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2736 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2737
2738 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2739 converted.
2740
2741 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2742 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2743 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2744 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2745 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2746 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2747 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002748 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2749 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002750
2751 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2752
2753 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2754 only need this line:
2755
2756 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2757
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002758tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2759 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002760 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002761 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2762 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2763 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2764 being used for too long.
2765
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002766tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2767 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2768 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2769 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2770 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2771 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2772 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2773 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2774 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2775 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2776 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002777 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002778 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002779
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002780tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2781 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2782 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2783 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2784 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002785 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002786 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2787 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002788 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2789 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002790
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002791tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2792 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2793 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2794 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2795 1000 entries.
2796
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002797tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2798 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2799 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2800 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2801
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002802tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002803tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002804tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2805tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2806tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002807 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2808 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2809 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2810 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2811 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2812 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2813 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2814 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002815
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002816 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2817 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2818 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2819 all available space is consumed.
2820 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2821 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2822 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002823
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002824tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2825 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002826 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002827 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002828 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002829 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2830
2831tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2832 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2833 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002834 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2835 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002836
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028373.3. Debugging
2838--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002839
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002840quiet
2841 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2842 line argument "-q".
2843
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002844zero-warning
2845 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2846 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2847 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2848 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2849 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2850 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2851
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002852
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010028533.4. Userlists
2854--------------
2855It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2856http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2857it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2858
2859userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002860 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002861 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2862
2863group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002864 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002865 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2866 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2867
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002868user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2869 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002870 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2871 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002872 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2873 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2874 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2875 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002876
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002877 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2878 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2879 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2880 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2881 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2882 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2883 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2884 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2885 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002886
2887 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002888 userlist L1
2889 group G1 users tiger,scott
2890 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002891
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002892 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2893 user scott insecure-password elgato
2894 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002895
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002896 userlist L2
2897 group G1
2898 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002899
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002900 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2901 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2902 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002903
2904 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002905
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002906
29073.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002908----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002909It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2910several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2911instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2912values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2913automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2914In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2915using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2916tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2917reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2918Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2919that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2920each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002921
2922peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002923 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002924 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2925
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002926bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2927 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2928 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2929
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002930disabled
2931 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2932 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2933 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2934
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002935default-bind [param*]
2936 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2937
2938default-server [param*]
2939 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2940
2941 Arguments:
2942 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2943 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2944 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2945 details.
2946
2947
2948 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2949
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002950enable
2951 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2952
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002953log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002954 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2955 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2956 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2957 more details.
2958
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002959peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002960 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2961 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002962 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2963 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2964 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2965 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2966 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002967
2968 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2969 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2970
2971 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002972 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2973 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2974 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002975
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002976 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2977 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002978
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002979 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2980 "server" keyword explanation below).
2981
2982server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002983 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002984 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2985 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2986 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2987 of this "peers" section).
2988 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2989
2990
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002991 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002992 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002993 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002994 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2995 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2996 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002997
2998 backend mybackend
2999 mode tcp
3000 balance roundrobin
3001 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3002 stick on src
3003
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003004 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3005 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003006
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003007 Example:
3008 peers mypeers
3009 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3010 default-server ssl verify none
3011 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3012 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003013
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003014
3015table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3016 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3017
3018 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3019 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003020 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003021 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3022 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3023 "stick-table" keyword).
3024
3025 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3026 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3027 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3028 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3029 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3030 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3031 of the stick-table name as follows:
3032
3033 peers mypeers
3034 peer A ...
3035 peer B ...
3036 table t1 ...
3037
3038 frontend fe1
3039 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3040
3041 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3042 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3043
3044 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3045 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3046 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3047 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3048 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3049 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3050 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3051
3052 peers mypeers
3053 peer A ...
3054 peer B ...
3055 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3056
3057 backend t1
3058 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3059
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003060 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003061 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3062 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3063
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090030643.6. Mailers
3065------------
3066It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3067If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3068in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3069
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003070mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003071 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3072 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3073
3074mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3075 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3076
3077 Example:
3078 mailers mymailers
3079 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3080 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3081
3082 backend mybackend
3083 mode tcp
3084 balance roundrobin
3085
3086 email-alert mailers mymailers
3087 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3088 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3089
3090 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3091 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3092
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003093timeout mail <time>
3094 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3095 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3096 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3097 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3098
3099 Example:
3100 mailers mymailers
3101 timeout mail 20s
3102 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003103
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031043.7. Programs
3105-------------
3106In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3107master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3108managed the same way as the workers.
3109
3110During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3111sequence as a worker:
3112
3113 - the master is re-executed
3114 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3115 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3116 instance of the program
3117
3118During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3119
3120program <name>
3121 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3122 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3123 the management guide).
3124
3125command <command> [arguments*]
3126 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3127 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3128 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3129 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3130
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003131user <user name>
3132 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3133 See also "group".
3134
3135group <group name>
3136 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3137 See also "user".
3138
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003139option start-on-reload
3140no option start-on-reload
3141 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3142 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3143 program section.
3144
3145
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010031463.8. HTTP-errors
3147----------------
3148
3149It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3150imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3151several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3152
3153http-errors <name>
3154 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3155 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3156
3157errorfile <code> <file>
3158 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3159
3160 Arguments :
3161 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003162 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003163 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003164
3165 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3166 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3167 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3168 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3169 before any chroot is performed.
3170
3171 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3172
3173 Example:
3174 http-errors website-1
3175 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3176 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3177 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3178
3179 http-errors website-2
3180 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3181 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3182 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3183
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020031843.9. Rings
3185----------
3186
3187It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3188servers or traces.
3189
3190ring <ringname>
3191 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3192
3193description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003194 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003195 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3196
3197format <format>
3198 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3199
3200 Arguments:
3201 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3202 one of the following :
3203
3204 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3205 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3206 designed to be used with a local log server.
3207
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003208 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3209 field is stripped. This is the default.
3210 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3211 rfc3164.
3212
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003213 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3214 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3215 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3216 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3217 is the default.
3218
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003219 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003220 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3221
3222 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3223 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3224
3225 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3226 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3227 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3228 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3229 logger consumes.
3230
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003231 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3232 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3233 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3234 with a local log server.
3235
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003236 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3237 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3238 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3239 used with a local log server.
3240
3241maxlen <length>
3242 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3243 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3244 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3245
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003246server <name> <address> [param*]
3247 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3248 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3249 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3250 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3251 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3252 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3253 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3254 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3255 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003256 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3257 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003258
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003259size <size>
3260 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3261 set to BUFSIZE.
3262
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003263timeout connect <timeout>
3264 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3265
3266 Arguments :
3267 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3268 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3269 as explained at the top of this document.
3270
3271timeout server <timeout>
3272 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3273
3274 Arguments :
3275 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3276 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3277 as explained at the top of this document.
3278
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003279 Example:
3280 global
3281 log ring@myring local7
3282
3283 ring myring
3284 description "My local buffer"
3285 format rfc3164
3286 maxlen 1200
3287 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003288 timeout connect 5s
3289 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003290 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003291
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020032923.10. Log forwarding
3293-------------------
3294
3295It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3296haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3297
3298log-forward <name>
3299 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3300
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003301backlog <conns>
3302 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3303 on connections accept.
3304
3305bind <addr> [param*]
3306 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003307 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3308 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3309 syslog protocol over TCP.
3310 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003311 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3312
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003313dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003314 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3315 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3316 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3317 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003318 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003319
3320log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003321log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003322 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3323 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3324 documentation.
3325 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3326 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3327 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3328 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3329 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3330
3331 Example:
3332 global
3333 log stderr format iso local7
3334
3335 ring myring
3336 description "My local buffer"
3337 format rfc5424
3338 maxlen 1200
3339 size 32764
3340 timeout connect 5s
3341 timeout server 10s
3342 # syslog tcp server
3343 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3344
3345 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003346 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3347 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003348 # all messages on stderr
3349 log global
3350 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3351 log ring@myring local0
3352 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3353 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3354 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3355 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3356 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003357
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003358maxconn <conns>
3359 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3360 10 is the default.
3361
3362timeout client <timeout>
3363 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3364
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033654. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003366----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003367
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003368Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003369 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3370 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3371 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3372 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003373
3374A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3375connections.
3376
3377A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3378to forward incoming connections.
3379
3380A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3381parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3382
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003383A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3384ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3385sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3386the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3387explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3388from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3389"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3390for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3391to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3392optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3393are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3394any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3395names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3396that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3397duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3398names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3399
3400Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3401settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3402of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3403profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3404timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3405
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003406All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3407'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3408case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3409
3410Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3411logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3412proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3413However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3414name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3415
3416Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3417and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003418bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003419protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3420modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3421arbitrary criteria.
3422
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003423In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3424a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003425the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003426
3427 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3428 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3429 between responses and new requests.
3430
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003431 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3432 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3433 client-facing connection remains open.
3434
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003435 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3436 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003437
3438The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3439frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3440following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003441weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003442
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003443 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003444
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003445 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3446 ----+-----+-----+----
3447 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3448 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003449 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3450 ----+-----+-----+----
3451 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003452
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003453It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
3454only HTTP traffic is handled. But It may be used to handle several protocols
3455into the same frontend. It this case, the client's connection is first handled
3456as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
3457content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data are parsed
3458and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3459possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003460
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003461There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
3462first ones concern the TCP to HTTP/1 upgrades. In HTTP/1, the request
3463processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
3464second ones concern the TCP to HTTP/2 upgrades. Because it is a multiplexed
3465protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3466is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3467new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
3468to understand this difference because that drastically change the way to
3469process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3470already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3471HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3472evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3473one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3474
3475There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3476performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3477tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3478preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3479analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3480HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3481header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3482mitigate this drawback.
3483
3484It exists two way to perform HTTP upgrades. The first one, the historical
3485method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3486set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3487in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3488is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3489to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3490above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3491to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3492"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3493frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3494frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3495as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3496upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3497on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3498the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3499upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3500frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3501remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003502
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035034.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3504--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003505
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003506The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3507limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3508they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3509limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003510marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003511option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003512and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3513with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3514specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003515
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003516
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003517 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3518------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3519acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003520backlog X X X -
3521balance X - X X
3522bind - X X -
3523bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003524capture cookie - X X -
3525capture request header - X X -
3526capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003527clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3528clitcpka-idle X X X -
3529clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003530compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003531cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003532declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003533default-server X - X X
3534default_backend X X X -
3535description - X X X
3536disabled X X X X
3537dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003538email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003539email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003540email-alert mailers X X X X
3541email-alert myhostname X X X X
3542email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003543enabled X X X X
3544errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003545errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003546errorloc X X X X
3547errorloc302 X X X X
3548-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3549errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003550force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003551filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003552fullconn X - X X
3553grace X X X X
3554hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003555http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003556http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003557http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003558http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003559http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003560http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003561http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003562http-check set-var X - X X
3563http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003564http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003565http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003566http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003567http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003568http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003569id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003570ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003571load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003572log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003573log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003574log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003575log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003576max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003577maxconn X X X -
3578mode X X X X
3579monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003580monitor-uri X X X -
3581option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3582option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3583option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3584option allbackups (*) X - X X
3585option checkcache (*) X - X X
3586option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3587option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003588option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003589option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3590option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003591-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3592option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003593option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3594option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003595option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003596option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003597option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003598option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003599option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003600option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3601option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3602option httpchk X - X X
3603option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003604option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003605option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003606option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003607option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003608option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003609option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3610option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3611option logasap (*) X X X -
3612option mysql-check X - X X
3613option nolinger (*) X X X X
3614option originalto X X X X
3615option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003616option pgsql-check X - X X
3617option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003618option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003619option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003620option smtpchk X - X X
3621option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3622option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3623option splice-request (*) X X X X
3624option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003625option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003626option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3627option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3628-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003629option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003630option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3631option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3632option tcpka X X X X
3633option tcplog X X X X
3634option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003635external-check command X - X X
3636external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003637persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3638rate-limit sessions X X X -
3639redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003640-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003641retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003642retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003643server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003644server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003645server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003646source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003647srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3648srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3649srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003650stats admin - X X X
3651stats auth X X X X
3652stats enable X X X X
3653stats hide-version X X X X
3654stats http-request - X X X
3655stats realm X X X X
3656stats refresh X X X X
3657stats scope X X X X
3658stats show-desc X X X X
3659stats show-legends X X X X
3660stats show-node X X X X
3661stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003662-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3663stick match - - X X
3664stick on - - X X
3665stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003666stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003667stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003668tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003669tcp-check connect X - X X
3670tcp-check expect X - X X
3671tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003672tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003673tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003674tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003675tcp-check set-var X - X X
3676tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003677tcp-request connection - X X -
3678tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003679tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003680tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003681tcp-response content - - X X
3682tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003683timeout check X - X X
3684timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003685timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003686timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003687timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3688timeout http-request X X X X
3689timeout queue X - X X
3690timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003691timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003692timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003693timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003694transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003695unique-id-format X X X -
3696unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003697use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003698use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003699use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003700------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3701 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003702
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003703
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037044.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3705---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003706
3707This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3708
3709
3710acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3711 Declare or complete an access list.
3712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3713 no | yes | yes | yes
3714 Example:
3715 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3716 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3717 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003719 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003720
3721
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003722backlog <conns>
3723 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3725 yes | yes | yes | no
3726 Arguments :
3727 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3728 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003729 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003730
3731 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3732 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3733 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3734 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3735 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3736 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3737 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3738 backlog parameter.
3739
3740 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3741 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3742 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3743
3744 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3745
3746
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003747balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003748balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003749 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3751 yes | no | yes | yes
3752 Arguments :
3753 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3754 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3755 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3756 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3757
3758 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3759 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3760 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3761 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003762 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003763 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003764 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3765 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3766 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3767 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3768 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3769 it, so that you don't worry.
3770
3771 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3772 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3773 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3774 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3775 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3776 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3777 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3778 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003779
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003780 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3781 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3782 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3783 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3784 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3785 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3786 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003787 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3788 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3789 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003790
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003791 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003792 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003793 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3794 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003795 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003796 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3797 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3798 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3799 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3800 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003801 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3802 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3803 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3804 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3805 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3806 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003807
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003808 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3809 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3810 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3811 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3812 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3813 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3814 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3815 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003816 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003817 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003818 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3819 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3820 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003821
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003822 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3823 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3824 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3825 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3826 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3827 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3828 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3829 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3830 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3831 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3832 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3833 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003834
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003835 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003836 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3837 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3838 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3839 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3840 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3841 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3842 URIs start with a leading "/".
3843
3844 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3845 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3846 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3847 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3848
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003849 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3850 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3851 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3852 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3853
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003854 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003855 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3856
3857 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003858 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3859 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003860 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3861 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3862 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3863 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003864 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003865 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3866 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003867
3868 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3869 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3870 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3871 server will receive the request.
3872
3873 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3874 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3875 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3876 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3877 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003878 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3879 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3880 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003881
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003882 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3883 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3884 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3885 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3886 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003887
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003888 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003889 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3890 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3891 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3892
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003893 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3894 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3895 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3896
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003897 random
3898 random(<draws>)
3899 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003900 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3901 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3902 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3903 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003904 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3905 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3906 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3907 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3908 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3909 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3910 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3911 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3912 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3913 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3914 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3915 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3916 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3917 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3918 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3919 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3920 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3921 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3922 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3923 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003924
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003925 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003926 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003927 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3928 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3929 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3930 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3931 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3932 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003933 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003934 used instead.
3935
3936 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3937 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3938 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3939 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3940
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003941 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3942 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3943 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3944
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003945 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003946
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003947 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003948 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3949 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003950
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003951 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3952 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3953 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003954
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003955 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003956 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003957 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3958 NTLM relies on.
3959
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003960 Examples :
3961 balance roundrobin
3962 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003963 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003964 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3965 balance hdr(host)
3966 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003967
3968 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3969 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3970
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003971 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003972 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3973 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3974 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003975 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003976
3977 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3978 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3979 defaults to 16 kB.
3980
3981 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3982 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3983
3984 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3985 Round Robin.
3986
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003987 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003988 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3989 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3990 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3991
3992 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3993
3994 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003995 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003996 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3997 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3998 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003999
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004000 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004001
4002
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004003bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4004bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004005 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4007 no | yes | yes | no
4008 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004009 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4010 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4011 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4012 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004013 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004014 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4015 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4016 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4017 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4018 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4019 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004020 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004021 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4022 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004023 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004024 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4025 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004026 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004027 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4028 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004029 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004030 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4031 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4032 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4033 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4034 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4035 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4036 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004037 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4038 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4039 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004040 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4041 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4042 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4043 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004044 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4045 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4046 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004047
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004048 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4049 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004050 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4051 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4052 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004053 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4054 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4055 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4056 the range.
4057
4058 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4059 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4060 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4061 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4062 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4063 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4064 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004065 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004066 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004067
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004068 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004069 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004070 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4071 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4072 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4073 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4074 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4075 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4076
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004077 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4078 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4079 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4080 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004081
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004082 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4083 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4084 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4085 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4086 in a frontend.
4087
4088 Example :
4089 listen http_proxy
4090 bind :80,:443
4091 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004092 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004093
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004094 listen http_https_proxy
4095 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004096 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004097
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004098 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4099 bind ipv6@:80
4100 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4101 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4102
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004103 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004104 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004105
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004106 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4107 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4108 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4109 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4110 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4111
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004112 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004113 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004114
4115
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004116bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004117 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4119 yes | yes | yes | yes
4120 Arguments :
4121 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4122 may be used to override a default value.
4123
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004124 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004125 option may be combined with other numbers.
4126
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004127 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004128 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4129 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4130 missing from all processes.
4131
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004132 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004133 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004134 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4135 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4136 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4137 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4138 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004139 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004140
4141 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4142 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4143 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4144 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4145 and 'even' instances.
4146
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004147 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4148 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4149 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4150 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004151
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004152 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4153 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4154
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004155 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4156 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4157 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4158
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004159 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4160 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4161
4162 Example :
4163 listen app_ip1
4164 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004165 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004166
4167 listen app_ip2
4168 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004169 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004170
4171 listen management
4172 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004173 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004174
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004175 listen management
4176 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4177 bind-process 1-4
4178
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004179 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004180
4181
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004182capture cookie <name> len <length>
4183 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4185 no | yes | yes | no
4186 Arguments :
4187 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4188 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4189 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4190 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004191 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004192
4193 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4194 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4195 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4196 right if it exceeds <length>.
4197
4198 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4199 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4200 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4201 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4202
4203 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4204 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4205 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4206
4207 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4208 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4209 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004210 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4211 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4212 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004213
4214 Example:
4215 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4216
4217 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004218 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004219
4220
4221capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004222 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4224 no | yes | yes | no
4225 Arguments :
4226 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004227 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004228 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4229 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4230 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4231
4232 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4233 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4234 it exceeds <length>.
4235
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004236 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004237 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4238 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004239 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4240 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4241 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4242 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004243 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004244 environments to find where the request came from.
4245
4246 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4247 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4248 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4249 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004250
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004251 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4252 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4253 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4254 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4255 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004256
4257 Example:
4258 capture request header Host len 15
4259 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004260 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004262 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004263 about logging.
4264
4265
4266capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004267 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4269 no | yes | yes | no
4270 Arguments :
4271 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004272 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004273 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4274 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4275 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4276
4277 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4278 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4279 it exceeds <length>.
4280
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004281 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004282 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4283 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4284 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004285 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4286 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4287 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4288 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004289
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004290 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4291 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4292 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4293 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4294 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004295
4296 Example:
4297 capture response header Content-length len 9
4298 capture response header Location len 15
4299
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004300 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004301 about logging.
4302
4303
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004304clitcpka-cnt <count>
4305 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4306 the connection on the client side.
4307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4308 yes | yes | yes | no
4309 Arguments :
4310 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4311
4312 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4313 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004314 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4315 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004316
4317 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4318
4319
4320clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4321 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4322 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4323 client side.
4324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4325 yes | yes | yes | no
4326 Arguments :
4327 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4328 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4329 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4330 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4331
4332 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4333 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004334 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4335 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004336
4337 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4338
4339
4340clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4341 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4343 yes | yes | yes | no
4344 Arguments :
4345 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4346 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4347 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4348 document.
4349
4350 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4351 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004352 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4353 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004354
4355 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4356
4357
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004358compression algo <algorithm> ...
4359compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004360compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004361 Enable HTTP compression.
4362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4363 yes | yes | yes | yes
4364 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004365 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4366 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4367 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4368
4369 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004370 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4371 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4372 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004373
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004374 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004375 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004376
4377 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4378 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4379 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4380 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4381 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004382 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004383
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004384 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4385 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4386 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4387 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4388 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4389 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4390 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004391 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004392
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004393 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004394 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004395 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4396 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4397 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4398 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4399 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004400
4401 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4402 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4403 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4404 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4405 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004406 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4407 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4408 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4409 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4410 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004411 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4412 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004413
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004414 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004415 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4416 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004417 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004418 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004419 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4420 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4421 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4422 "multipart"
4423 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4424 header
4425 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4426 and later
4427 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4428 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004429 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004430
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004431 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004432
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004433 Examples :
4434 compression algo gzip
4435 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004436
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004437
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004438cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004439 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4440 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004441 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004442 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4444 yes | no | yes | yes
4445 Arguments :
4446 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4447 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4448 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4449 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4450 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4451 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004452 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004453 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4454 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4455
4456 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4457 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4458 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4459 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4460 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4461 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004462 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4463 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004464 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004465 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4466 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004467
4468 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004469 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004470
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004471 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004472 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004473 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004474 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004475 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4476 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4477 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4478 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4479 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4480 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4481 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004482
4483 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4484 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4485 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4486 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4487 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4488 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4489 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4490 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4491 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004492 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004493 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4494 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4495 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004496
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004497 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4498 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4499 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004500 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4501 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4502 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4503 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004504 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4505 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4506 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004507
4508 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4509 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4510 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4511 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4512 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4513 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4514 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4515 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4516 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4517
4518 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4519 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4520 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4521 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4522 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4523 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4524 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4525 persistence cookie in the cache.
4526 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4527
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004528 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4529 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4530 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4531 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4532 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004533 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004534 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4535 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4536 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4537 they logout.
4538
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004539 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4540 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4541 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4542 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4543
4544 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4545 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4546 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4547 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4548 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4549 this attribute.
4550
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004551 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004552 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004553 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4554 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4555 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4556 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4557 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4558 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004559
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004560 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4561 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4562 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4563 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4564 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4565 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4566 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4567 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004568 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004569 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4570 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4571 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4572 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4573 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4574 the site.
4575
4576 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4577 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4578 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4579 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4580 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4581 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4582 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4583 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4584 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4585 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4586 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4587 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4588 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004589 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004590 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4591 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4592
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004593 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4594 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4595 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4596 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4597 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4598 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4599
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004600 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4601 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4602 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4603 repeated.
4604
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004605 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4606 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4607 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4608 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004609
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004610 Examples :
4611 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4612 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4613 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004614 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004615
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004616 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004617
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004618
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004619declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4620 Declares a capture slot.
4621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4622 no | yes | yes | no
4623 Arguments:
4624 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4625
4626 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4627 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4628 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4629 for use in the response.
4630
4631 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004632 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004633 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4634
4635
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004636default-server [param*]
4637 Change default options for a server in a backend
4638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4639 yes | no | yes | yes
4640 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004641 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4642 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4643 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4644 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004645
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004646 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004647 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4648
4649 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004650
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004651
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004652default_backend <backend>
4653 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4655 yes | yes | yes | no
4656 Arguments :
4657 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4658
4659 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4660 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4661 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4662 will catch all undetermined requests.
4663
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004664 Example :
4665
4666 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4667 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4668 default_backend dynamic
4669
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004670 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004671
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004672
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004673description <string>
4674 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4676 no | yes | yes | yes
4677 Arguments : string
4678
4679 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4680 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4681 it describes.
4682 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4683
4684
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004685disabled
4686 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4688 yes | yes | yes | yes
4689 Arguments : none
4690
4691 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4692 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4693 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4694 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4695 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4696 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4697 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4698
4699 See also : "enabled"
4700
4701
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004702dispatch <address>:<port>
4703 Set a default server address
4704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4705 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004706 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004707
4708 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4709 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4710 during start-up.
4711
4712 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4713 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4714 possible with normal servers.
4715
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004716 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004717 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4718 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4719 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4720 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4721
4722 See also : "server"
4723
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004724
4725dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4726 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4728 yes | no | yes | yes
4729 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4730
4731 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004732 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004733 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4734 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004735 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004736 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004737
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004738enabled
4739 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4741 yes | yes | yes | yes
4742 Arguments : none
4743
4744 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4745 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4746
4747 See also : "disabled"
4748
4749
4750errorfile <code> <file>
4751 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4753 yes | yes | yes | yes
4754 Arguments :
4755 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004756 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004757 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004758
4759 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004760 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004761 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004762 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4763 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004764
4765 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4766 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4767 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4768
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004769 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4770
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004771 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4772 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4773 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4774 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4775 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4776 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4777 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4778 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4779 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004780
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004781 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4782 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4783 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004784 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004785 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4786
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004787 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004788
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004789 Example :
4790 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004791 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004792 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4793 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4794
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004795
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004796errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4797 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4798 section.
4799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4800 yes | yes | yes | yes
4801 Arguments :
4802 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4803
4804 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004805 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004806 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4807 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004808
4809 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4810 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4811 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4812 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4813 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004814 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004815 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4816
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004817 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4818 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004819
4820 Example :
4821 errorfiles generic
4822 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4823
4824
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004825errorloc <code> <url>
4826errorloc302 <code> <url>
4827 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4829 yes | yes | yes | yes
4830 Arguments :
4831 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004832 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004833 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004834
4835 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4836 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4837 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4838 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004839 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004840
4841 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4842 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4843 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4844
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004845 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4846
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004847 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4848 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4849 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4850 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004851 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004852 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4853 request.
4854
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004855 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004856
4857
4858errorloc303 <code> <url>
4859 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4861 yes | yes | yes | yes
4862 Arguments :
4863 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004864 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004865 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004866
4867 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4868 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4869 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4870 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004871 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004872
4873 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4874 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4875 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4876
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004877 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4878
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004879 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4880 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4881 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4882 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004883 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004884
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004885 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004886
4887
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004888email-alert from <emailaddr>
4889 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004890 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004891 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4892 yes | yes | yes | yes
4893
4894 Arguments :
4895
4896 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4897
4898 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4899 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4900
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004901 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004902 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4903 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004904
4905
4906email-alert level <level>
4907 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4908 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4909 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4910 yes | yes | yes | yes
4911
4912 Arguments :
4913
4914 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4915 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4916 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4917
4918 By default level is alert
4919
4920 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4921 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4922 for the proxy.
4923
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004924 Alerts are sent when :
4925
4926 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4927 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4928 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4929 is notice or lower
4930 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4931 and a health check status update occurs
4932
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004933 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4934 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004935 section 3.6 about mailers.
4936
4937
4938email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4939 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4940 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4941 yes | yes | yes | yes
4942
4943 Arguments :
4944
4945 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4946
4947 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4948 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4949
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004950 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4951 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004952
4953
4954email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4955 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4956 mailers.
4957 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4958 yes | yes | yes | yes
4959
4960 Arguments :
4961
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004962 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004963
4964 By default the systems hostname is used.
4965
4966 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4967 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4968 for the proxy.
4969
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004970 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4971 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004972
4973
4974email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004975 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004976 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4977 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4978 yes | yes | yes | yes
4979
4980 Arguments :
4981
4982 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4983
4984 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4985 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4986
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004987 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004988 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4989
4990
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004991force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4992 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4993 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004994 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004995
4996 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4997 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4998 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4999 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5000 marked down for maintenance operations.
5001
5002 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5003 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5004 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5005 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5006 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5007 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5008 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5009 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5010 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5011
5012 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5013 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5014 is used.
5015
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005016 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005017 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005018
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005019
5020filter <name> [param*]
5021 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5023 no | yes | yes | yes
5024 Arguments :
5025 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5026 referenced in section 9.
5027
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005028 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005029 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005030 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5031 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005032
5033 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5034 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5035
5036 Example:
5037 listen
5038 bind *:80
5039
5040 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5041 filter compression
5042 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5043
5044 compression algo gzip
5045 compression offload
5046
5047 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5048
5049 See also : section 9.
5050
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005051
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005052fullconn <conns>
5053 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5055 yes | no | yes | yes
5056 Arguments :
5057 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5058 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5059
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005060 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005061 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005062 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005063 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5064 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5065 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5066 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5067 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005068 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005069
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005070 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
5071 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005072 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5073 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5074 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005075
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005076 Example :
5077 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5078 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5079 # connections.
5080 backend dynamic
5081 fullconn 10000
5082 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5083 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5084
5085 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5086
5087
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005088grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005089 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005091 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005092 Arguments :
5093 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5094 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5095 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5096
5097 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5098 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005099 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005100 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5101
5102 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5103 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5104 simplify it.
5105
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005106
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005107hash-balance-factor <factor>
5108 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5110 yes | no | no | yes
5111 Arguments :
5112 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5113 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005114 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005115
5116 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5117 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5118 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5119 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5120 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5121 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5122 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5123
5124 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5125 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5126 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5127 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5128 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5129
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005130 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5131 consistent hashing mechanism.
5132
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005133 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5134
5135
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005136hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005137 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5139 yes | no | yes | yes
5140 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005141 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5142 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005143
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005144 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5145 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5146 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5147 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5148 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5149 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5150 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5151 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5152 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5153 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005154
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005155 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5156 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5157 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5158 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5159 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5160 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5161 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5162 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5163 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5164 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5165 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5166 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5167 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005168 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5169 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005170
5171 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5172
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005173 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005174 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5175 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5176 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005177 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5178 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5179 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005180
5181 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5182 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005183 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5184 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5185 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5186 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5187
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005188 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
5189 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5190 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5191 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5192 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5193 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5194 parameter.
5195
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005196 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5197 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5198 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5199 used on strings.
5200
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005201 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5202
5203 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5204 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5205 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5206 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5207 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5208 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5209 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5210 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5211 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5212 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5213 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5214 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005215
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005216 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5217 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5218 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005219
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005220 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005221
5222
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005223http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5224 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5225 ones).
5226
5227 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5228 no | yes | yes | yes
5229
5230 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5231 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5232 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5233 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5234 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5235 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5236
5237 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5238 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5239 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5240
5241 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5242 below.
5243
5244 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5245 instance.
5246
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005247 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5248 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5249 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5250
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005251 Example:
5252 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5253 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5254 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5255
5256http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5257
5258 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5259 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5260 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5261 example, or to pass some internal information.
5262 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5263 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5264 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5265
5266http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5267
5268 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5269 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5270
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005271http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005272
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005273 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5274 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5275 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5276 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5277 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005278
5279http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5280 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5281
5282 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5283
5284 Example:
5285 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5286
5287 # applied to:
5288 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5289
5290 # outputs:
5291 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5292
5293 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5294
5295http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5296 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5297
5298 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5299
5300 Example:
5301 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5302
5303 # applied to:
5304 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5305
5306 # outputs:
5307 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5308
5309http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5310
5311 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5312 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5313 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5314
5315http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5316 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5317
5318 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5319 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5320 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5321 fallback.
5322
5323 Example:
5324 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5325 http-response set-status 431
5326 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5327 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5328
5329http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5330
5331 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5332 inline.
5333
5334 Arguments:
5335 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5336 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5337 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5338 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5339 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5340 (request and response)
5341 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5342 processing
5343 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5344 processing
5345 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5346 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5347 and '_'.
5348
5349 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5350 followed by some converters.
5351
5352 Example:
5353 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5354
5355http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5356
5357 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5358 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5359 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5360 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5361 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005362 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005363 processing.
5364
5365 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5366 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005367 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005368 rules evaluation.
5369
5370http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5371
5372 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5373 details about <var-name>.
5374
5375 Example:
5376 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5377
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005378
5379http-check comment <string>
5380 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5381 it fails.
5382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5383 yes | no | yes | yes
5384
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005385 Arguments :
5386 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5387 rule fails.
5388
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005389 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5390 user-friendly error reporting.
5391
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005392 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005393 "http-check expect".
5394
5395
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005396http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5397 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005398 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005399 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5401 yes | no | yes | yes
5402
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005403 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005404 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5405
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005406 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005407 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005408
5409 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5410 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5411 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5412 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5413
5414 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5415
5416 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5417
5418 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5419
5420 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5421
5422 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5423
5424 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5425 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5426 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5427 is used.
5428
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005429 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5430 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5431 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5432 haproxy -vv.
5433
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005434 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5435
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005436 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5437 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5438 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5439 different ports or with different servers.
5440
5441 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5442 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5443 the port with a "http-check connect".
5444
5445 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5446 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5447 do.
5448
5449 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5450 unset-var or comment rules.
5451
5452 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005453 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5454 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5455 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5456 option httpchk
5457
5458 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005459 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005460 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005461 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005462 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005463 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005464
5465 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5466
5467 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005468
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005469
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005470http-check disable-on-404
5471 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005473 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005474 Arguments : none
5475
5476 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5477 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5478 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5479 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5480 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5481 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5482 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5483 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005484 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5485 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005486 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5487 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5488 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005489
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005490 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005491
5492
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005493http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005494 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5495 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5496 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005497 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005499 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005500
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005501 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005502 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5503
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005504 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5505 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5506 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5507 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5508 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5509 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5510 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5511 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5512 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5513 result is always conclusive.
5514
5515 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5516 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5517 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005518 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5519 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005520 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5521 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005522 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5523 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5524 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005525
5526 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5527 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005528 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5529 supported :
5530 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5531 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005532 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5533 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5534 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5535 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5536 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005537
5538 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5539 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005540 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5541 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5542 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5543 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005544 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5545
5546 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5547 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5548 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5549 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5550
5551 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5552 informational message reported in logs if an error
5553 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5554 log-format string.
5555
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005556 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005557 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5558 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005559 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5560 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5561 details on the supported keywords.
5562
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005563 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5564 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5565 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5566 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005567
5568 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5569 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5570 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5571 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5572 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5573
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005574 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5575 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5576 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5577 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5578 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5579 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5580 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005581
5582 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005583 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005584 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5585 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5586 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5587 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5588
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005589 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5590 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005591 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5592 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5593 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5594 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5595 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5596 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5597 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5598 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005599 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5600 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5601 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5602 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5603 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5604 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5605 insensitive on the header names.
5606
5607 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5608 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5609 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5610 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5611 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5612 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005613
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005614 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005615 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005616 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5617 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5618 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5619 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5620 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005621 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005622 trace).
5623
5624 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005625 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005626 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5627 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5628 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5629 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5630 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005631 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005632
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005633 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5634 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5635 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5636 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5637 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5638 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5639
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005640 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005641 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005642 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5643 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5644 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5645 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5646 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5647 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5648
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005649 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5650 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5651 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5652 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5653 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005654
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005655 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5656 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5657
5658 Examples :
5659 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005660 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005661
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005662 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5663 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5664
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005665 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005666 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005667
5668 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005669 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005670
5671 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005672 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005673
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005674 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005675 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005676
5677
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005678http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005679 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5680 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005681 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5682 health checks.
5683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5684 yes | no | yes | yes
5685 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005686 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5687
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005688 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5689 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5690 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5691 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5692 to invent non-standard ones.
5693
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005694 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5695 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5696 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5697 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5698
5699 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5700 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5701 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5702 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005703
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005704 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005705 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005706 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005707 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5708 to add it.
5709
5710 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5711 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5712 to the log-format rules.
5713
5714 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5715 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5716 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005717
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005718 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5719 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5720 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5721 request.
5722
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005723 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5724 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5725 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005726 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5727 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5728 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5729 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005730 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005731
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005732 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005733 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5734 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005735
5736 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5737 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5738 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5739 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5740 configured request authority.
5741
5742 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5743 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005744
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005745 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005746
5747
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005748http-check send-state
5749 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5751 yes | no | yes | yes
5752 Arguments : none
5753
5754 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5755 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5756 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5757 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5758 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5759
5760 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5761 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5762 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5763 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5764 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005765 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5766 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5767 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5768
5769 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5770 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5771 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5772
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005773 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5774 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5775 checked in multiple backends.
5776
5777 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5778 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5779
5780 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5781 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5782 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5783 one fails.
5784
5785 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5786 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5787 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5788
5789 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5790 server's queue.
5791
5792 Example of a header received by the application server :
5793 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5794 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5795
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005796 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5797 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005798
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005799
5800http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005801 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005802 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5803 yes | no | yes | yes
5804
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005805 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005806 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5807 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5808 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5809 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5810 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5811 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5812 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5813 and '-'.
5814
5815 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5816
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005817 Examples :
5818 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005819
5820
5821http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005822 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005823 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5824 yes | no | yes | yes
5825
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005826 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005827 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5828 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5829 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5830 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5831 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5832 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5833 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5834 and '-'.
5835
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005836 Examples :
5837 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005838
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005839
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005840http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5841 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5842 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5843 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5844 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5846 yes | yes | yes | yes
5847 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005848 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005849 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005850 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005851 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005852
5853 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5854 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5855 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5856 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5857
5858 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5859 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5860 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5861 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5862
5863 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5864 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5865 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5866 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5867 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5868 chroot is performed.
5869
5870 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5871 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5872 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5873 considered.
5874
5875 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5876 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5877 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5878 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5879 considered as a raw string.
5880
5881 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5882 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5883 "content-type".
5884
5885 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5886 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5887 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5888 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5889 evaluated as a log-format string.
5890
5891 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5892 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5893 argument to "content-type".
5894
5895 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5896 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5897 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5898 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5899
5900 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5901 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5902 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5903 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5904 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5905 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5906 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5907 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5908
5909 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5910 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5911 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5912
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005913 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5914 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5915 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5916 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5917 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5918
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005919 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5920 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5921
5922
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005923http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005924 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5925
5926 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5927 no | yes | yes | yes
5928
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005929 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5930 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5931 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5932 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5933 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005934
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005935 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5936 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005937
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005938 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005939
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005940 Example:
5941 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5942 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5943 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005944
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005945 http-request allow if nagios
5946 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5947 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5948 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005949
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005950 Example:
5951 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5952 acl add path /addacl
5953 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005954
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005955 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005956
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005957 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5958 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005959
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005960 Example:
5961 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5962 acl setmap path /setmap
5963 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005964
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005965 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005966
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005967 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5968 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005969
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005970 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5971 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005972
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005973http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005974
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005975 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5976 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5977 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5978 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5979 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5980 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5981 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5982 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005983
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005984http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005985
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005986 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5987 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5988 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5989 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5990 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5991 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5992 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5993 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005994
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005995http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005996
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005997 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5998 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005999
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006000
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006001http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006002
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006003 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6004 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6005 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6006 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6007 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006008
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006009 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6010 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6011 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6012 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6013 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6014 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6015 instead.
6016
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006017 Example:
6018 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6019 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006020
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006021http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006022
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006023 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006024
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006025http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6026 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006027
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006028 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6029 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6030 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6031 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6032 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6033 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6034 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6035 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6036 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006037
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006038 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6039 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6040 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006041 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6042
6043 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6044 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6045 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6046 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006047
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006048http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006049
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006050 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6051 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6052 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6053 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6054 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6055 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006056
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006057http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006058
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006059 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6060 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6061 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6062 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6063 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006064
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006065http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006066
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006067 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6068 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6069 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6070 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6071 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6072 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006073
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006074http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6075http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6076 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6077 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6078 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6079 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006080
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006081 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6082 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6083 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006084 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006085 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6086 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6087 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006088 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006089 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006090
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006091http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6092 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6093 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6094 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6095
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006096http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6097
6098 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6099 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6100 pointed by <resolvers>.
6101 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6102 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6103 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6104 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6105 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6106 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6107 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6108 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6109 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6110 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6111 to 0.0.0.0.
6112
6113 Example:
6114 resolvers mydns
6115 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6116 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6117 timeout retry 1s
6118 hold valid 10s
6119 hold nx 3s
6120 hold other 3s
6121 hold obsolete 0s
6122 accepted_payload_size 8192
6123
6124 frontend fe
6125 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6126 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6127 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6128
6129 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6130 # which mean DNS resolution error
6131 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6132
6133 default_backend be
6134
6135 backend b_503
6136 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6137 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6138 # 503 error page to end users
6139
6140 backend be
6141 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6142 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6143 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6144 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6145 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6146
6147 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6148 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6149
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006150http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6151
6152 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6153 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6154 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6155 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006156 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6157 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006158
6159 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6160
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006161http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006162http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006163http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006164http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006165http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006166http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6167http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006168
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006169 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6170
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006171 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
6172 technical preview. You should be prepared that the behavior of normalizers
6173 might change to fix possible issues, possibly breaking proper request
6174 processing in your infrastructure.
6175
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006176 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6177 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6178 the supported backend.
6179
6180 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6181 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6182 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6183 number of segments in the path.
6184
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006185 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6186 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6187 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6188 when improperly combined.
6189
6190 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6191 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6192 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6193 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6194 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6195
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006196 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006197
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006198 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6199 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006200
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006201 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6202 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6203
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006204 Example:
6205 - /. -> /
6206 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6207 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6208 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006209
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006210 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6211 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6212
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006213 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006214 their preceding segment.
6215
6216 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6217 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6218
6219 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6220 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006221
6222 Example:
6223 - /foo/../ -> /
6224 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6225 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6226 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006227 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006228 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006229 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006230
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006231 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6232 removed as well:
6233
6234 Example:
6235 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6236 - /bar/../../ -> /
6237
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006238 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6239 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006240
6241 Example:
6242 - // -> /
6243 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6244
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006245 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6246 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6247
6248 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6249 ".", "_", and "~".
6250
6251 Example:
6252 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6253 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6254 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6255 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6256
6257 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6258 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6259
6260 Example:
6261 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6262 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6263
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006264 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006265 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006266
6267 Example:
6268 - /%6f -> /%6F
6269 - /%zz -> /%zz
6270
6271 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6272 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6273
6274 Example:
6275 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6276
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006277 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006278 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6279 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6280
6281 Example:
6282 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6283 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6284 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6285
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006286http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006287
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006288 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6289 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6290 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6291 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6292 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006293
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006294http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006295
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006296 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6297 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6298 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6299 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006300
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006301http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6302 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006303
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006304 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006305 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6306 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6307 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6308 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6309 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006310
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006311 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6312 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6313 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6314 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6315 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006316
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006317 Example:
6318 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6319
6320 # applied to:
6321 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6322
6323 # outputs:
6324 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6325
6326 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006327
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006328 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6329
6330 # applied to:
6331 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006332
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006333 # outputs:
6334 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006335
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006336http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6337 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6338
6339 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6340 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006341 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6342 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6343 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006344
6345 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6346 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6347 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6348
6349 Example:
6350 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6351 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6352
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006353 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6354 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6355 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6356 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6357
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006358http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6359 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6360
6361 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6362 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6363 query-string are replaced.
6364
6365 Example:
6366 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6367 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6368
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006369http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6370 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6371
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006372 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6373 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6374 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6375 against.
6376
6377 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6378 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6379 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006380
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006381 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6382 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6383 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6384 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6385 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6386 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6387 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6388 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6389 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006390 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6391 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006392
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006393 Example:
6394 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6395 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006396
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006397 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6398 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006399
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006400http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6401 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006402
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006403 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6404 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6405 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6406 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006407
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006408 Example:
6409 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006410
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006411 # applied to:
6412 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006413
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006414 # outputs:
6415 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006416
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006417http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6418 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6419 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006420 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006421 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6422
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006423 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006424 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6425 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006426 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006427 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006428 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006429 are followed to create the response :
6430
6431 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6432 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6433 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6434 ignored.
6435
6436 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6437 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006438 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006439 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6440 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006441
6442 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6443 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6444 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006445 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6446 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006447
6448 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6449 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6450 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006451 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006452 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006453 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006454
6455 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6456 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6457 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6458 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6459 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6460 as a raw content.
6461
6462 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6463 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6464 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6465 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6466 considered as a raw string.
6467
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006468 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006469 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6470 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6471 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6472
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006473 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6474 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006475 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006476
6477 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6478
6479 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006480 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006481 if { path /ping }
6482
6483 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6484 if { path /favicon.ico }
6485
6486 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6487 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6488 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6489
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006490http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6491http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006492
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006493 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6494 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6495 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006496
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006497http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6498 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006499
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006500 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6501 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6502 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6503 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006504
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006505http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006506
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006507 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6508 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6509 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6510 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6511 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006512
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006513 Arguments:
6514 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6515 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006516
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006517 Example:
6518 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6519 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006520
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006521 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6522 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006523
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006524http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006525
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006526 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6527 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6528 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006529
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006530 Arguments:
6531 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6532 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006533
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006534 Example:
6535 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6536 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006537
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006538 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6539 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6540 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006541
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006542http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006543
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006544 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6545 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6546 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6547 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6548 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006549
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006550 Example:
6551 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6552 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6553 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6554 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6555 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6556 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6557 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6558 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6559 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006560
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006561http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006562
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006563 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6564 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6565 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6566 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6567 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006569http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6570 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006571
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006572 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6573 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6574 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6575 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6576 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6577 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6578 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6579 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6580 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006581
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006582http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006583
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006584 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6585 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6586 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6587 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6588 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6589 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6590 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006592http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006594 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6595 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6596 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006597
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006598http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006599
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006600 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6601 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6602 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6603 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6604 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6605 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6606 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6607 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006608
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006609http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006611 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6612 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6613 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6614 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6615 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6616 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006617
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006618 Example :
6619 # prepend the host name before the path
6620 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006621
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006622http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6623
6624 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6625 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6626 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6627
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006628http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006629
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006630 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6631 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6632 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6633 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6634 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006635
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006636http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006637
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006638 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6639 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6640 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6641 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6642 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6643 values have higher priority.
6644 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6645 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6646 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6647 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6648 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006649
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006650http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006652 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6653 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6654 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6655 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6656 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6657 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6658 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006659
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006660 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006661
6662 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006663 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6664 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006665
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006666http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6667 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6668 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6669 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006670 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6671 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006672
6673 Arguments :
6674 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6675 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006676
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006677 See also "option forwardfor".
6678
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006679 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006680 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6681 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6682
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006683 # After the masking this will track connections
6684 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6685 http-request track-sc0 src
6686
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006687 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6688 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6689
6690http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6691
6692 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6693 expression.
6694
6695 Arguments:
6696 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6697 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006698
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006699 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006700 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6701 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6702
6703 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6704 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6705 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6706
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006707http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006708 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6709
6710 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6711 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6712 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6713 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6714 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6715
6716 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6717 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6718 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6719 results.
6720
6721 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006722 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6723 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006724
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006725http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6726
6727 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6728 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6729 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6730 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6731 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6732 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6733 information from the request.
6734
6735 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6736
6737http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6738
6739 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6740 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6741 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6742 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6743 path and the query string.
6744 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6745
6746http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6747
6748 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6749 inline.
6750
6751 Arguments:
6752 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6753 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6754 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6755 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6756 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6757 (request and response)
6758 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6759 processing
6760 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6761 processing
6762 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6763 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6764 and '_'.
6765
6766 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6767 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006768
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006769 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006770 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006771
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006772http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6773 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006774
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006775 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6776 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6777 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6778 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6779 agent name must be used.
6780
6781 Arguments:
6782 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6783
6784 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6785 configuration.
6786
6787http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6788
6789 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6790 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6791 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6792 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6793 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6794 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6795 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6796 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6797 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6798 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6799 action.
6800 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6801 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6802 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6803 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6804 you fully understand how it works.
6805
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006806http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6807
6808 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6809 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6810 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6811 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6812 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006813 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006814 processing.
6815
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006816 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006817 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6818 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6819 rules evaluation.
6820
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006821http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6822http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6823 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6824 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6825 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6826 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006827
6828 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6829 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6830 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006831 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6832 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6833 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6834 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6835 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6836 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6837 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6838 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6839 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6840 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006841 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006842 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6843 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6844 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6845 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6846 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006847
6848http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6849http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6850http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6851
6852 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6853 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6854 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6855 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006856 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006857 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6858 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6859 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6860 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6861 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6862 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6863 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6864
6865 Arguments :
6866 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6867 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6868 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6869 select which table entry to update the counters.
6870
6871 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6872 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6873 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6874 that table until the session ends.
6875
6876 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6877 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6878 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6879 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6880 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6881 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6882 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6883 useful information.
6884
6885 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6886 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6887 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6888 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6889 checks that make use of it.
6890
6891http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6892
6893 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006894
6895 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006896 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006897
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006898http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6899
6900 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6901 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6902 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6903 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6904 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6905 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6906
6907 Arguments :
6908 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6909
6910 Example:
6911 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6912
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006913http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6914 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6915
6916 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6917 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6918 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6919 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6920 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6921 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6922 http-buffer-request".
6923
6924 Arguments :
6925
6926 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6927 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6928
6929 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05006930 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006931 bytes.
6932
6933 Example:
6934 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6935
6936 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6937
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006938http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006939
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006940 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6941 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6942 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006943
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006944
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006945http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006946 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6947
6948 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6949 no | yes | yes | yes
6950
6951 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6952 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6953 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6954 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6955 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6956 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6957
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006958 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6959 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006960
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006961 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006962
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006963 Example:
6964 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006965
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006966 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006967
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006968 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6969 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006970
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006971 Example:
6972 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006973
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006974 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006975
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006976 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6977 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006978
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006979 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6980 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006981
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006982http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006983
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006984 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6985 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6986 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6987 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6988 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6989 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6990 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6991 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006992
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006993http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006994
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006995 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6996 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6997 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6998 example, or to pass some internal information.
6999 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7000 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7001 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007002
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007003http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007004
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007005 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7006 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007007
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007008http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007009
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007010 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007011
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007012http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007013
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007014 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7015 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7016 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7017 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7018 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7019 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7020 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007021
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007022 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7023 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7024 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7025 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7026 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007027
7028 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7029 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7030 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7031 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007032
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007033http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007034
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007035 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7036 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7037 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7038 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7039 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7040 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007041
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007042http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007043
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007044 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7045 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7046 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7047 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7048 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007049
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007050http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007051
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007052 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7053 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7054 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7055 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7056 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7057 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007058
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007059http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7060http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7061 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7062 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7063 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7064 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007065
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007066 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7067 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7068 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007069 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007070 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7071 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7072 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007073 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007074 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007075
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007076http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007078 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7079 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7080 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7081 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7082 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7083 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007084
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007085http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7086 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007087
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007088 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7089 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007090
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007091 Example:
7092 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007093
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007094 # applied to:
7095 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007096
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007097 # outputs:
7098 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007099
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007100 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007101
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007102http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7103 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007104
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007105 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007106 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007107
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007108 Example:
7109 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007110
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007111 # applied to:
7112 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007113
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007114 # outputs:
7115 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007116
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007117http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7118 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7119 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007120 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007121 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7122
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007123 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007124 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7125 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007126 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007127 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007128 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007129 are followed to create the response :
7130
7131 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7132 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7133 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7134 ignored.
7135
7136 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7137 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007138 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007139 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7140 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007141
7142 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7143 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7144 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007145 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
7146 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007147
7148 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7149 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7150 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007151 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007152 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007153 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007154
7155 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7156 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7157 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7158 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7159 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7160 as a raw content.
7161
7162 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7163 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7164 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7165 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7166 considered as a raw string.
7167
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007168 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7169 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7170 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7171 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7172
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007173 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7174 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007175 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007176
7177 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7178
7179 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007180 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007181 if { status eq 404 }
7182
7183 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7184 string "This is the end !" \
7185 if { status eq 500 }
7186
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007187http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7188http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007189
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007190 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7191 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7192 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007193
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007194http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7195 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007196
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007197 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7198 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7199 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7200 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007201
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007202http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007203
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007204 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7205 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7206 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7207 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7208 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007209
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007210 Arguments:
7211 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007212
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007213 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7214 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007215
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007216http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007217
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007218 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7219 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7220 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007221
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007222http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7223
7224 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7225 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7226 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7227 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7228 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7229
7230http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7231
7232 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7233 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7234 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7235 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7236 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7237 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7238 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7239 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7240 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7241
7242http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7243
7244 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7245 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7246 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7247 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7248 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7249 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7250 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7251
7252http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7253
7254 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7255 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7256 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7257 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7258 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7259 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7260 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7261 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7262
7263http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7264 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7265
7266 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7267 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7268 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7269 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007270
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007271 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007272 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7273 http-response set-status 431
7274 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7275 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007276
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007277http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007278
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007279 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7280 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7281 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7282 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7283 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7284 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7285 based on some information from the request.
7286
7287 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7288
7289http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7290
7291 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7292 inline.
7293
7294 Arguments:
7295 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7296 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7297 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7298 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7299 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7300 (request and response)
7301 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7302 processing
7303 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7304 processing
7305 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7306 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7307 and '_'.
7308
7309 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7310 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007311
7312 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007313 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007314
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007315http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007316
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007317 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7318 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7319 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7320 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7321 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7322 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7323 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7324 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7325 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7326 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7327 action.
7328 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7329 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7330 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7331 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7332 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007333
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007334http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7335
7336 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7337 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7338 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7339 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7340 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007341 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007342 processing.
7343
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007344 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007345 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007346 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007347 rules evaluation.
7348
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007349http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7350http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7351http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007352
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007353 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7354 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7355 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7356 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7357 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
7358 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
7359
7360http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7361
7362 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7363 about <var-name>.
7364
7365 Example:
7366 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7367
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007368http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7369 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7370
7371 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7372 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7373 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7374 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7375 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7376 buffer is full.
7377
7378 Arguments :
7379
7380 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7381 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7382
7383 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007384 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007385 bytes.
7386
7387 Example:
7388 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007389
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007390http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7391 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7392
7393 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7394 yes | no | yes | yes
7395
7396 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007397 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7398 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7399 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007400
7401 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7402
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007403 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7404 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7405 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7406 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7407 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7408 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7409 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
7410 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
7411 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7412 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007413
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007414 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7415 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7416 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7417 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7418 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7419 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7420 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007421 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7422 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7423 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7424 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7425 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7426 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007427
7428 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7429 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7430 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7431 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7432 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7433 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7434 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7435 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007436 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007437 downsides of rare connection failures.
7438
7439 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7440 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7441 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7442 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7443 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7444 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007445 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007446 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7447 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7448 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7449 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7450 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7451
7452 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007453 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7454 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7455 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7456 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007457
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007458 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7459 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007460
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007461 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007462
7463 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7464 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7465 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7466
7467 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7468
7469
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007470http-send-name-header [<header>]
7471 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007472 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7473 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007474 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007475 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7476
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007477 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7478 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7479 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7480 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7481 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7482 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7483 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7484 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7485 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7486 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7487 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7488 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7489 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7490 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7491 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7492 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007493
7494 See also : "server"
7495
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007496id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007497 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7499 no | yes | yes | yes
7500 Arguments : none
7501
7502 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7503 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7504 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007505
7506
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007507ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7508 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7509 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007510 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007511
7512 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7513 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7514 and running).
7515
7516 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7517 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7518 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007519 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007520 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7521
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007522 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7523 "unless" condition is met.
7524
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007525 Example:
7526 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7527 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7528 ignore-persist if url_static
7529
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007530 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7531
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007532load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7533 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7534 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7535 yes | no | yes | yes
7536
7537 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7538 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7539 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007540 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007541 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7542 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7543 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7544 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7545
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007546 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007547 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007548 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007549
7550 Arguments:
7551 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7552 named "server-state-file".
7553
7554 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7555 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7556 name is used as a file name.
7557
7558 none don't load any stat for this backend
7559
7560 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007561 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7562 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7563 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007564 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007565 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007566
7567 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7568 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7569
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007570 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007571
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007572 global
7573 stats socket /tmp/socket
7574 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007575
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007576 defaults
7577 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007578
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007579 backend bk
7580 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7581 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007582
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007583
7584 Then one can run :
7585
7586 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7587
7588 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7589
7590 1
7591 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7592 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7593 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7594
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007595 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007596
7597 global
7598 stats socket /tmp/socket
7599 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7600
7601 defaults
7602 load-server-state-from-file local
7603
7604 backend bk
7605 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7606 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7607
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007608
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007609 Then one can run :
7610
7611 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7612
7613 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7614
7615 1
7616 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7617 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7618 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7619
7620 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7621 "show servers state"
7622
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007623
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007624log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007625log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007626 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007627no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007628 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7630 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007631
7632 Prefix :
7633 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7634 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7635 prefix does not allow arguments.
7636
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007637 Arguments :
7638 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7639 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7640 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7641 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7642 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7643 parameter.
7644
7645 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7646 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7647
7648 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7649 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7650 standard syslog port).
7651
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007652 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7653 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7654 standard syslog port).
7655
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007656 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7657 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7658 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007659 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007660
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007661 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7662 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7663 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7664 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7665 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7666 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7667 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7668 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7669 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7670 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7671 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7672 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7673 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7674 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7675 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7676 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007677 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7678 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007679
7680 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7681 and "fd@2", see above.
7682
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007683 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7684 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7685 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7686 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7687 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7688 having the logs instantly available.
7689
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007690 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7691 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7692 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7693
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007694 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7695 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007696
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007697 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7698 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7699 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7700 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7701 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7702 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7703 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7704 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7705 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7706 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007707 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007708
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007709 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7710 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7711 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7712 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7713 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7714
7715 <sample_size>
7716 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7717 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7718 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7719 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7720 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7721
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007722 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7723 one of the following :
7724
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007725 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7726 field is stripped. This is the default.
7727 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7728 rfc3164.
7729
7730 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007731 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7732
7733 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7734 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7735
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007736 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7737 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7738 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7739 designed to be used with a local log server.
7740
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007741 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7742 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7743 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7744 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7745 systemd logger consumes.
7746
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007747 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7748 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7749 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7750 used with a local log server.
7751
7752 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7753 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7754 designed to be used with a local log server.
7755
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007756 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7757 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7758 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7759 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7760
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007761 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7762
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007763 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7764 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7765 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7766
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007767 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7768 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7769 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7770 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007771
7772 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7773 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7774 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007775 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7776 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7777 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7778 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7779 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007780
7781 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7782
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007783 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7784 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7785 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007786
7787 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7788 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7789 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7790 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7791
7792 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7793 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007794
7795 Example :
7796 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007797 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7798 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7799 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007800 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007801 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7802 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007803 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007804
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007805
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007806log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007807 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7808 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7809 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007810
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007811 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7812 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7813 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7814 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7815 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007816
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007817 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7818 "option httplog" directives.
7819
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007820log-format-sd <string>
7821 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7822 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7823 yes | yes | yes | no
7824
7825 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7826 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7827 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7828 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7829 which covers the log format string in depth.
7830
7831 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7832 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7833
7834 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7835 log format to "rfc5424".
7836
7837 Example :
7838 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7839
7840
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007841log-tag <string>
7842 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7843 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7844 yes | yes | yes | yes
7845
7846 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7847 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7848 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7849 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7850 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7851 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7852 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7853 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7854 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007855
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007856max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7857 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7858 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7859 yes | no | yes | yes
7860
7861 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7862 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7863 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7864 servers.
7865
7866 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7867 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7868 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7869 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7870 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007871 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007872 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7873 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7874 picking a different server.
7875
7876 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7877 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7878 even if they have to be queued.
7879
7880 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7881 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7882
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007883max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7884 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7885 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7886 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007887
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007888maxconn <conns>
7889 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7891 yes | yes | yes | no
7892 Arguments :
7893 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7894 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7895 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7896 closes.
7897
7898 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7899 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7900 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7901 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007902 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7903 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7904 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7905 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007906
7907 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7908 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7909 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7910
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007911 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7912 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007913
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007914 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7915
7916
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007917mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007918 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7920 yes | yes | yes | yes
7921 Arguments :
7922 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7923 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7924 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7925 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7926
7927 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7928 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7929 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7930 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7931 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7932
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007933 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7934 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7935 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007936
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007937 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007938 defaults http_instances
7939 mode http
7940
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007941
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007942monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007943 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7945 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007946 Arguments :
7947 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7948 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007949 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007950 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7951 backend and its backup.
7952
7953 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7954 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7955 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7956 servers in a list of backends.
7957
7958 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7959 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7960 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7961 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7962 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7963 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7964 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007965 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7966 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007967
7968 Example:
7969 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007970 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007971 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7972 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7973 monitor-uri /site_alive
7974 monitor fail if site_dead
7975
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007976 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007977
7978
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007979monitor-uri <uri>
7980 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7982 yes | yes | yes | no
7983 Arguments :
7984 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7985 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7986
7987 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7988 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7989 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7990 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7991 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7992 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7993 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7994 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7995
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007996 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007997 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7998 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7999 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8000 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8001 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8002 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008003
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008004 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8005 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8006 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8007 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8008
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008009 Example :
8010 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
8011 frontend www
8012 mode http
8013 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8014
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008015 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008016
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008017
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008018option abortonclose
8019no option abortonclose
8020 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8022 yes | no | yes | yes
8023 Arguments : none
8024
8025 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8026 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8027 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8028 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008029 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008030 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8031 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8032 encountered while delivering the response.
8033
8034 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8035 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8036 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8037 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8038 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8039 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008040 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008041 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008042 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008043 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8044 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8045 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8046
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008047 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8048 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008049 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8050 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8051 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8052 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8053 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8054 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008055 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008056
8057 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8058 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8059
8060 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8061
8062
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008063option accept-invalid-http-request
8064no option accept-invalid-http-request
8065 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8067 yes | yes | yes | no
8068 Arguments : none
8069
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008070 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008071 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008072 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008073 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8074 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8075 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8076 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8077 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008078 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8079 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8080 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8081 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008082 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008083 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008084 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8085 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8086 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008087
8088 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8089 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8090 been confirmed.
8091
8092 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8093 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008094 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8095 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008096 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8097
8098 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8099 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8100
8101 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8102 stats socket.
8103
8104
8105option accept-invalid-http-response
8106no option accept-invalid-http-response
8107 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8109 yes | no | yes | yes
8110 Arguments : none
8111
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008112 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008113 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008114 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008115 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8116 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8117 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8118 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8119 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008120 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8121 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8122 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008123
8124 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8125 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8126 been confirmed.
8127
8128 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8129 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8130 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8131 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8132
8133 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8134 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8135
8136 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8137 stats socket.
8138
8139
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008140option allbackups
8141no option allbackups
8142 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8144 yes | no | yes | yes
8145 Arguments : none
8146
8147 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8148 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8149 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8150 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8151 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8152 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8153 order between the backup servers anymore.
8154
8155 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8156 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8157
8158 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8159 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8160
8161
8162option checkcache
8163no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008164 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8166 yes | no | yes | yes
8167 Arguments : none
8168
8169 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8170 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008171 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008172 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8173 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008174 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008175
8176 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008177 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008178 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008179 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8180 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008181 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008182 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008183 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8184 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008185 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008186 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8187 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008188 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008189 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8190 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8191 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8192 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8193 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8194 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8195 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8196 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8197 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8198
8199 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008200 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8201 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8202 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8203 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008204
8205 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8206 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008207 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008208 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008209
8210 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8211 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8212
8213
8214option clitcpka
8215no option clitcpka
8216 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8218 yes | yes | yes | no
8219 Arguments : none
8220
8221 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8222 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008223 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008224 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8225
8226 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8227 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8228 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8229 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8230
8231 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8232 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8233 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8234 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8235 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8236
8237 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8238
8239 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8240 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8241 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8242
8243 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8244 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8245
8246 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8247
8248
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008249option contstats
8250 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8252 yes | yes | yes | no
8253 Arguments : none
8254
8255 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8256 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8257 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
8258 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008259 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8260 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8261 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8262 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8263 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008264
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008265option disable-h2-upgrade
8266no option disable-h2-upgrade
8267 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8268 connection.
8269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8270 yes | yes | yes | no
8271 Arguments : none
8272
8273 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8274 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8275 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8276 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008277 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8278 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8279 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8280 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8281 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8282 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008283
8284 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8285 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008286
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008287option dontlog-normal
8288no option dontlog-normal
8289 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8291 yes | yes | yes | no
8292 Arguments : none
8293
8294 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8295 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8296 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8297 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8298 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8299 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8300 logged.
8301
8302 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8303 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8304 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8305
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008306 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008307 logging.
8308
8309
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008310option dontlognull
8311no option dontlognull
8312 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8314 yes | yes | yes | no
8315 Arguments : none
8316
8317 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8318 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8319 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8320 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8321 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8322 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008323 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8324 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8325 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008326
8327 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008328 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008329 would not be logged.
8330
8331 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8332 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8333
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008334 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008335 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008336
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008337
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008338option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008339 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8341 yes | yes | yes | yes
8342 Arguments :
8343 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8344 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008345 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008346 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008347
8348 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8349 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8350 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8351 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8352 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8353 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8354 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008355 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8356 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8357 possible that the client has already brought one.
8358
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008359 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008360 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008361 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008362 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008363 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008364 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008365
8366 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8367 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8368 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8369 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8370 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8371 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008372 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008373
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008374 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8375 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
8376 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
8377 are under the control of the end-user.
8378
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008379 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008380 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8381 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008382 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8383 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8384 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008385
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008386 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008387 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8388 frontend www
8389 mode http
8390 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8391
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008392 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8393 backend www
8394 mode http
8395 option forwardfor header X-Client
8396
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008397 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008398 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008399
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008400
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008401option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8402no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8403 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8405 yes | yes | yes | no
8406 Arguments : none
8407
8408 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8409 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8410 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8411 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8412 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8413 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8414 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8415
8416 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8417 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8418 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8419 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8420 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8421 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8422 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8423 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8424 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8425 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8426
8427 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8428
8429 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8430 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8431
8432 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8433 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8434
8435
8436option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8437no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8438 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8440 yes | no | yes | yes
8441 Arguments : none
8442
8443 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8444 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8445 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8446 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8447 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8448 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8449 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8450
8451 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8452 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8453 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8454 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8455 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8456 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8457 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8458 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8459 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8460 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8461
8462 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8463
8464 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8465 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8466
8467 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8468 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8469
8470
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008471option http-buffer-request
8472no option http-buffer-request
8473 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8475 yes | yes | yes | yes
8476 Arguments : none
8477
8478 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8479 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8480 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8481 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8482 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8483 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008484 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8485 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8486 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8487 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008488
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008489 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8490 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008491
8492
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008493option http-ignore-probes
8494no option http-ignore-probes
8495 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8497 yes | yes | yes | no
8498 Arguments : none
8499
8500 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8501 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8502 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8503 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8504 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8505 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8506 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8507 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8508 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008509 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8510 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008511 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8512
8513 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8514 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8515 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8516 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8517 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8518 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8519 are often the only way to detect them.
8520
8521 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8522 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8523
8524 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8525
8526
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008527option http-keep-alive
8528no option http-keep-alive
8529 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8531 yes | yes | yes | yes
8532 Arguments : none
8533
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008534 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8535 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008536 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8537 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008538 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8539 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8540 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008541
8542 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8543 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008544 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8545 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8546 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8547 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8548 situations where this option may be useful :
8549
8550 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008551 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008552
8553 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8554 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8555
8556 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8557 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8558 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8559 request.
8560
8561 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8562 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008563 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8564 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8565 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008566
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008567 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8568 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8569 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8570 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8571 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8572 not set.
8573
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008574 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8575 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8576 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008577
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008578 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008579 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008580 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008581
8582
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008583option http-no-delay
8584no option http-no-delay
8585 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8587 yes | yes | yes | yes
8588 Arguments : none
8589
8590 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8591 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8592 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8593 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8594 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8595 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8596 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8597 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8598 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8599 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8600 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8601 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8602 affected.
8603
8604 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8605 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8606 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8607 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8608 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8609 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8610 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8611 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8612 latency environments.
8613
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008614 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8615
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008616
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008617option http-pretend-keepalive
8618no option http-pretend-keepalive
8619 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008621 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008622 Arguments : none
8623
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008624 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008625 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8626 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8627 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8628 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8629 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8630 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8631 consider the response complete.
8632
8633 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8634 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8635 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8636 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008637 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008638 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8639
8640 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8641 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8642 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8643 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8644 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8645 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8646 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8647
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008648 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8649 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8650 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8651 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8652 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8653 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008654
8655 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8656 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8657
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008658 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008659 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008660
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008661
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008662option http-server-close
8663no option http-server-close
8664 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8666 yes | yes | yes | yes
8667 Arguments : none
8668
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008669 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8670 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8671 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8672 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008673 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8674 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8675 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8676 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8677 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8678 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8679 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8680 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8681 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8682 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8683 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008684
8685 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8686 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8687 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8688 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008689 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8690 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008691
8692 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8693 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008694 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8695 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8696 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008697
8698 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8699 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8700
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008701 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8702 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008703
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008704option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008705no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008706 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8708 yes | yes | yes | no
8709 Arguments : none
8710
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008711 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008712 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8713 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8714 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8715 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8716 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8717 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8718
8719 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8720 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008721 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8722 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8723 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008724
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008725 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8726 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8727 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8728 front of an existing proxy.
8729
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008730 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8731
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008732 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008733
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008734option httpchk
8735option httpchk <uri>
8736option httpchk <method> <uri>
8737option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008738 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8740 yes | no | yes | yes
8741 Arguments :
8742 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8743 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8744 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8745 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8746 ones.
8747
8748 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8749 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8750 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8751
8752 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8753 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8754 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008755 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008756
8757 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8758 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8759 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8760 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8761 the lack of any response.
8762
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008763 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8764 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8765 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8766 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8767
8768 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8769 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8770 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008771
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008772 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8773 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008774 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008775 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008776 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008777
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008778 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8779 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8780 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8781 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8782
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008783 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008784 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8785 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8786 backend https_relay
8787 mode tcp
8788 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8789 http-check send hdr Host www
8790 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008791
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008792 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8793 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8794 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008795
8796
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008797option httpclose
8798no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008799 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8801 yes | yes | yes | yes
8802 Arguments : none
8803
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008804 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8805 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8806 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8807 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008808 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008809
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008810 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8811 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008812 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008813 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8814 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008815
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008816 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8817 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8818 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008819
8820 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8821 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008822 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8823 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8824 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008825
8826 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8827 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8828
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008829 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008830
8831
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008832option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008833 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008835 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008836 Arguments :
8837 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8838 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8839 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008840 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008841 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008842
8843 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8844 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8845 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8846 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8847 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8848 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8849 ports.
8850
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008851 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8852 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008853
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008854 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8855
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008856 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008857
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008858
8859option http_proxy
8860no option http_proxy
8861 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8863 yes | yes | yes | yes
8864 Arguments : none
8865
8866 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8867 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8868 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8869 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8870 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8871
8872 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8873 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008874 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8875 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008876
8877 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8878 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8879
8880 Example :
8881 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8882 backend direct_forward
8883 option httpclose
8884 option http_proxy
8885
8886 See also : "option httpclose"
8887
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008888
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008889option independent-streams
8890no option independent-streams
8891 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8893 yes | yes | yes | yes
8894 Arguments : none
8895
8896 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8897 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8898 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8899 receive data or not.
8900
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008901 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008902 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8903 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8904 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8905 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8906 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8907 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8908 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8909 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8910 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8911 socket buffers.
8912
8913 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8914 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8915 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8916 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8917 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8918
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008919 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008920
8921
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008922option ldap-check
8923 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8925 yes | no | yes | yes
8926 Arguments : none
8927
8928 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8929 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8930 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8931 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8932
8933 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8934 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8935
8936 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8937 configure it.
8938
8939 Example :
8940 option ldap-check
8941
8942 See also : "option httpchk"
8943
8944
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008945option external-check
8946 Use external processes for server health checks
8947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8948 yes | no | yes | yes
8949
8950 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8951 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8952 command".
8953
8954 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8955
8956 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8957
8958
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008959option log-health-checks
8960no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008961 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8963 yes | no | yes | yes
8964 Arguments : none
8965
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008966 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8967 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8968 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008969
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008970 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8971 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8972 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8973 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8974 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8975
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008976 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008977 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008978
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008979 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8980 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8981 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008982
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008983
8984option log-separate-errors
8985no option log-separate-errors
8986 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8988 yes | yes | yes | no
8989 Arguments : none
8990
8991 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8992 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8993 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8994 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8995 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8996 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8997 provides very important information.
8998
8999 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9000 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9001 error logs.
9002
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009003 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009004 logging.
9005
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009006
9007option logasap
9008no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009009 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9011 yes | yes | yes | no
9012 Arguments : none
9013
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009014 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9015 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9016 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9017 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9018
9019 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9020 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9021 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9022 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9023 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009024 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009025 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9026 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9027 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9028 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009029 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009030
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009031 Examples :
9032 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9033 mode http
9034 option httplog
9035 option logasap
9036 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9037
9038 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9039 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9040 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9041 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9042
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009043 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009044 logging.
9045
9046
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009047option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009048 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9050 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009051 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009052 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9053 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009054 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9055 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009056
9057 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9058 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009059 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009060 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
9061 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
9062 in the MySQL table, like this :
9063
9064 USE mysql;
9065 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
9066 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
9067
9068 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009069 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009070 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9071 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9072 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9073 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9074 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9075 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9076 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9077
9078 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9079 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009080
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009081 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009082
9083 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9084 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9085 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9086 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009087 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
9088 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009089
9090 See also: "option httpchk"
9091
9092
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009093option nolinger
9094no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009095 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009096 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9097 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009098 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009099
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009100 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009101 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9102 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9103 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9104 connections.
9105
9106 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9107 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009108 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9109 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9110 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9111 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9112 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9113 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9114 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9115 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9116 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9117 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9118 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9119 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9120 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009121
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009122 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9123 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9124 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9125 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9126 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009127
9128 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9129 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009130 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009131 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009132 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009133
9134 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9135 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9136
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009137 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9138 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009139
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009140option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9141 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9143 yes | yes | yes | yes
9144 Arguments :
9145 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9146 matching <network>
9147 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9148 header name.
9149
9150 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9151 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9152 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9153 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9154 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9155 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9156 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9157 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9158 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9159 possible that the client has already brought one.
9160
9161 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9162 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9163 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9164 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9165 header and requires different one.
9166
9167 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9168 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9169 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009170 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9171 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9172 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9173 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9174 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009175
9176 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9177 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9178 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9179 both are defined.
9180
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009181 Examples :
9182 # Original Destination address
9183 frontend www
9184 mode http
9185 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9186
9187 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9188 backend www
9189 mode http
9190 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9191
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009192 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009193
9194
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009195option persist
9196no option persist
9197 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9198 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9199 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009200 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009201
9202 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9203 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9204 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9205 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9206 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9207 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9208 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9209 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9210 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9211 redirected to another valid server.
9212
9213 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9214 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9215
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009216 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009217
9218
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009219option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9220 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9222 yes | no | yes | yes
9223 Arguments :
9224 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9225 PostgreSQL server.
9226
9227 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9228 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9229 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9230 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9231
9232 See also: "option httpchk"
9233
9234
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009235option prefer-last-server
9236no option prefer-last-server
9237 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9238 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9239 yes | no | yes | yes
9240 Arguments : none
9241
9242 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
9243 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
9244 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9245 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
9246 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
9247 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
9248 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
9249 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9250 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009251 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
9252 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009253 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9254 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9255 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009256 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9257 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9258 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009259
9260 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9261 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9262
9263 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9264
9265
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009266option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009267option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009268no option redispatch
9269 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9270 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9271 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009272 Arguments :
9273 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9274 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9275 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009276 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009277 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009278 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009279 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9280 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9281 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009283
9284 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9285 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9286 be able to access the service anymore.
9287
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009288 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9289 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009290
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009291 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9292 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9293 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9294 following order:
9295
9296 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9297
9298 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9299 list, or
9300
9301 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9302
9303 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9304 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9305
9306 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9307 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9308 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9309 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9310
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009311 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009312 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9313 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009314
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009315 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9316 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9317
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009318 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009319
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009320
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009321option redis-check
9322 Use redis health checks for server testing
9323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9324 yes | no | yes | yes
9325 Arguments : none
9326
9327 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9328 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9329 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9330 find the "+PONG" response message.
9331
9332 Example :
9333 option redis-check
9334
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009335 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009336
9337
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009338option smtpchk
9339option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9340 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9342 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009343 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009344 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009345 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009346 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9347
9348 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9349 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9350 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9351
9352 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9353 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9354 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9355 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9356 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9357 dead server.
9358
9359 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9360 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009361 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009362 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9363
9364 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9365 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9366 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9367 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009368 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009369
9370 Example :
9371 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9372
9373 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9374
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009375
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009376option socket-stats
9377no option socket-stats
9378
9379 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9381 yes | yes | yes | no
9382
9383 Arguments : none
9384
9385
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009386option splice-auto
9387no option splice-auto
9388 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9390 yes | yes | yes | yes
9391 Arguments : none
9392
9393 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
9394 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009395 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009396 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009397 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009398 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9399 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9400 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9401 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9402
9403 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9404 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9405 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9406 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9407 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9408 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9409 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9410 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9411 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9412 keyword.
9413
9414 Example :
9415 option splice-auto
9416
9417 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9418 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9419
9420 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9421 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9422
9423
9424option splice-request
9425no option splice-request
9426 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9428 yes | yes | yes | yes
9429 Arguments : none
9430
9431 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009432 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009433 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9434 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9435 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9436 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9437
9438 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9439
9440 Example :
9441 option splice-request
9442
9443 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9444 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9445
9446 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9447 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9448
9449
9450option splice-response
9451no option splice-response
9452 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9454 yes | yes | yes | yes
9455 Arguments : none
9456
9457 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009458 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009459 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9460 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9461 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9462 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9463
9464 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9465
9466 Example :
9467 option splice-response
9468
9469 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9470 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9471
9472 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9473 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9474
9475
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009476option spop-check
9477 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9479 no | no | no | yes
9480 Arguments : none
9481
9482 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9483 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9484 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9485 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9486
9487 Example :
9488 option spop-check
9489
9490 See also : "option httpchk"
9491
9492
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009493option srvtcpka
9494no option srvtcpka
9495 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9497 yes | no | yes | yes
9498 Arguments : none
9499
9500 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9501 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009502 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009503 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9504
9505 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9506 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9507 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9508 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9509
9510 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9511 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9512 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9513 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9514 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9515
9516 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9517
9518 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9519 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9520 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9521
9522 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9523 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9524
9525 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9526
9527
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009528option ssl-hello-chk
9529 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9531 yes | no | yes | yes
9532 Arguments : none
9533
9534 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9535 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9536 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9537 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9538 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9539 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9540 hello message.
9541
9542 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9543 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9544 messages, which is appreciable.
9545
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009546 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9547 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9548 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009549
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009550 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9551
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009552
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009553option tcp-check
9554 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9555 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9556 yes | no | yes | yes
9557
9558 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9559 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9560
9561 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9562 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9563 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9564
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009565 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009566 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9567 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9568 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9569 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9570 only.
9571
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009572 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009573 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9574 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9575 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9576 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9577
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009578 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009579 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9580 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009581 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009582 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9583 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9584 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9585 the respective protocols.
9586 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009587 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009588
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009589 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009590
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009591 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9592 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9593 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9594 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009595
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009596 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9597 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9598 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009599
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009600
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009601 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009602 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009603 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009604 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009605
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009606 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009607 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009608 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009609
9610 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9611 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009612 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009613 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009614 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009615 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009616 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009617 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009618 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9619 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009620 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009621 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9622 tcp-check expect string +OK
9623
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009624 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009625 (send many headers before analyzing)
9626 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009627 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009628 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9629 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9630 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9631 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009632 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009633
9634
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009635 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009636
9637
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009638option tcp-smart-accept
9639no option tcp-smart-accept
9640 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9642 yes | yes | yes | no
9643 Arguments : none
9644
9645 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9646 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9647 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9648 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9649 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9650 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9651
9652 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9653 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9654 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9655 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9656
9657 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9658 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9659 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009660 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009661
9662 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9663 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9664 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9665
9666 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9667 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9668 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9669
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009670 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9671
9672
9673option tcp-smart-connect
9674no option tcp-smart-connect
9675 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9677 yes | no | yes | yes
9678 Arguments : none
9679
9680 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9681 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9682 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9683 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9684 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9685
9686 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9687 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9688 complex.
9689
9690 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9691 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9692 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9693
9694 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9695 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9696
9697 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9698
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009699
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009700option tcpka
9701 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9703 yes | yes | yes | yes
9704 Arguments : none
9705
9706 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9707 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009708 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009709 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9710
9711 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9712 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9713 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9714 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9715
9716 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9717 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9718 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9719 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9720 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9721
9722 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9723
9724 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9725 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9726 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9727 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9728 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9729 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9730 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9731 backends.
9732
9733 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9734
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009735
9736option tcplog
9737 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009739 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009740 Arguments : none
9741
9742 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9743 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9744 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9745 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9746 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9747 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9748 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9749 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9750
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009751 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9752
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009753 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009754
9755
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009756option transparent
9757no option transparent
9758 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009760 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009761 Arguments : none
9762
9763 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9764 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9765 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9766 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9767 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9768 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9769 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9770 appropriate server.
9771
9772 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9773 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9774
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009775 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009776 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009777
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009778
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009779external-check command <command>
9780 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9782 yes | no | yes | yes
9783
9784 Arguments :
9785 <command> is the external command to run
9786
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009787 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9788
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009789 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009790
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009791 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9792 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9793 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9794 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9795 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9796 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009797
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009798 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9799
9800 Environment variables :
9801 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9802 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9803
9804 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9805
9806 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9807
9808 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9809 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9810 for a UNIX socket).
9811
9812 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9813
9814 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9815
9816 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9817
9818 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9819
9820 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9821
9822 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9823 socket).
9824
9825 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9826 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9827
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009828 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9829
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009830 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9831 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9832 failed.
9833
9834 Example :
9835 external-check command /bin/true
9836
9837 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9838
9839
9840external-check path <path>
9841 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9843 yes | no | yes | yes
9844
9845 Arguments :
9846 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9847
9848 The default path is "".
9849
9850 Example :
9851 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9852
9853 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9854 "external-check command"
9855
9856
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009857persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009858persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009859 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9861 yes | no | yes | yes
9862 Arguments :
9863 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009864 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9865 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009866
9867 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9868 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009869 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009870 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9871 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9872 forwarded to this server.
9873
9874 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9875 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9876 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009877 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009878 a single "listen" section.
9879
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009880 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9881 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9882 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9883
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009884 Example :
9885 listen tse-farm
9886 bind :3389
9887 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9888 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9889 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9890 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9891 persist rdp-cookie
9892 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009893 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009894 balance rdp-cookie
9895 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9896 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9897
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009898 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9899 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009900
9901
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009902rate-limit sessions <rate>
9903 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9905 yes | yes | yes | no
9906 Arguments :
9907 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9908 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9909
9910 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9911 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9912 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9913 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9914 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9915 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9916
9917 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9918 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9919 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9920 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9921
9922 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9923 listen smtp
9924 mode tcp
9925 bind :25
9926 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009927 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009928
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009929 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9930 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9931 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009932
9933 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9934
9935
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009936redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9937redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9938redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009939 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9941 no | yes | yes | yes
9942
9943 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009944 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009945
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009946 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009947 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009948 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9949 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9950 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009951
9952 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9953 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9954 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9955 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9956 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009957 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9958 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9959 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9960 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009961
9962 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9963 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9964 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9965 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9966 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9967 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009968 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009969 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009970 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9971 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9972 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009973
9974 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009975 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9976 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9977 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009978 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009979 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9980 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9981 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9982 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009983
9984 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009985 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009986
9987 - "drop-query"
9988 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9989 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9990 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9991 with a location-type redirect.
9992
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009993 - "append-slash"
9994 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9995 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9996 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9997 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9998
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009999 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10000 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10001 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10002 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10003 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10004 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10005 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10006
10007 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10008 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10009 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10010 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10011 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10012 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10013 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010014
10015 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10016 acl clear dst_port 80
10017 acl secure dst_port 8080
10018 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010019 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010020 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010021 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10022
10023 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010024 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10025 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10026 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010027 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010028
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010029 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10030 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10031 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10032
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010033 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010034 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010035
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010036 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010037 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10038 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10039 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010040
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010041 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010042
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010043
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010044retries <value>
10045 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10046 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10047 yes | no | yes | yes
10048 Arguments :
10049 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10050 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10051 default value is 3.
10052
10053 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10054 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10055 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10056
10057 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010058 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10059 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010060
10061 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10062 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10063
10064 See also : "option redispatch"
10065
10066
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010067retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010068 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10069 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10070 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010071 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10072 yes | no | yes | yes
10073 Arguments :
10074 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
10075 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
10076 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
10077 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
10078
10079 none never retry
10080
10081 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10082 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10083
10084 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10085 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10086 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10087 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10088 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10089 processing the request.
10090
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010091 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10092 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10093 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10094 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10095 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10096 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10097 overflow attack for example).
10098
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010099 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10100 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10101 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10102 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10103 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10104 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10105 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10106 amplify denial of service attacks.
10107
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010108 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10109 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10110 considered to be safe to retry.
10111
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010112 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10113 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10114 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10115 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10116 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010117
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010118 all-retryable-errors
10119 retry request for any error that are considered
10120 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10121 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10122 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10123
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010124 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10125 not cumulative.
10126
10127 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10128 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10129 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10130 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10131
10132 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10133 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10134 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10135 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10136 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10137 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10138 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10139 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10140 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10141 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10142 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10143 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10144
10145 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10146 should not use this directive.
10147
10148 The default is "conn-failure".
10149
10150 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10151
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010152server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010153 Declare a server in a backend
10154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10155 no | no | yes | yes
10156 Arguments :
10157 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010158 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010159 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010160
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010161 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10162 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10163 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10164 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010165 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10166 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
10167 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
10168 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10169 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010170 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10171 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10172 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10173 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10174 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10175 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10176 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010177 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010178 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10179 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10180 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10181 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10182 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10183 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010184 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10185 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010186 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10187 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010188
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010189 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010190 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10191 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10192 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10193 adding this value to the client's port.
10194
10195 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10196 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010197 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010198
10199 Examples :
10200 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10201 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010202 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010203 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10204 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10205 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010206
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010207 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10208 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10209 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10210 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10211 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10212
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010213 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10214 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010215
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010216server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010217 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010218 this backend.
10219 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10220 no | no | yes | yes
10221
10222 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10223 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10224 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10225 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10226 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010227
10228 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10229 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10230
10231 global
10232 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10233
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010234 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010235 load-server-state-from-file
10236
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010237 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010238 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010239
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010240server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10241 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10242 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10244 no | no | yes | yes
10245
10246 Arguments:
10247 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10248
10249 <num | range>
10250 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10251 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10252 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10253 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10254
10255 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10256
10257 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10258
10259 <params*>
10260 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10261 keyword.
10262
10263 Examples:
10264 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10265 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10266 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10267
10268 # or
10269 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10270
10271 # would be equivalent to:
10272 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10273 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10274 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10275
10276
10277
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010278source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010279source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010280source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010281 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10283 yes | no | yes | yes
10284 Arguments :
10285 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10286 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010287
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010288 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010289 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10290 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10291 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10292 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10293 supported prefixes are :
10294 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10295 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10296 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010297 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010298 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10299 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010300
10301 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10302 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010303 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10304 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10305 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010306
10307 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10308 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10309 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10310 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10311 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10312 <addr>.
10313
10314 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10315 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10316 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10317 port.
10318
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010319 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10320 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10321 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10322 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010323 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010324 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10325 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10326 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10327 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10328 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10329 HTTP header.
10330
10331 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10332 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010333 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010334 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10335 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10336 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10337 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10338 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10339 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10340 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10341
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010342 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10343 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10344 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10345 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10346 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10347 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10348
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010349 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10350 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10351 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10352 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10353
10354 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10355 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10356 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10357 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10358 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10359 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10360
10361 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10362 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10363 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10364 there are two methods :
10365
10366 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10367 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10368 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10369 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10370 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10371 of the client ranges may be used.
10372
10373 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10374 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10375 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10376 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10377 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10378 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10379 same session.
10380
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010381 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10382 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10383 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010384 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010385
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010386 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10387
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010388 Examples :
10389 backend private
10390 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10391 source 192.168.1.200
10392
10393 backend transparent_ssl1
10394 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10395 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10396
10397 backend transparent_ssl2
10398 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10399 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10400 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10401
10402 backend transparent_ssl3
10403 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10404 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10405 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10406
10407 backend transparent_smtp
10408 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10409 # with Tproxy version 4.
10410 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10411
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010412 backend transparent_http
10413 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10414 # proxy.
10415 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10416
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010417 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010418 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10419
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010420
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010421srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10422 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10423 the connection on the server side.
10424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10425 yes | no | yes | yes
10426 Arguments :
10427 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10428
10429 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10430 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010431 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10432 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010433
10434 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10435
10436
10437srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10438 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10439 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10440 server side.
10441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10442 yes | no | yes | yes
10443 Arguments :
10444 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10445 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10446 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10447 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10448
10449 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10450 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010451 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10452 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010453
10454 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10455
10456
10457srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10458 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10460 yes | no | yes | yes
10461 Arguments :
10462 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10463 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10464 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10465 document.
10466
10467 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10468 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010469 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10470 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010471
10472 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10473
10474
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010475stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10476 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010478 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010479
10480 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10481 matched.
10482
10483 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10484 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10485
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010486 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10487 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010488 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010489
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010490 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10491 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10492 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10493 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010494
10495 Example :
10496 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10497 backend stats_localhost
10498 stats enable
10499 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10500
10501 Example :
10502 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10503 backend stats_auth
10504 stats enable
10505 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10506 stats admin if TRUE
10507
10508 Example :
10509 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10510 userlist stats-auth
10511 group admin users admin
10512 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10513 group readonly users haproxy
10514 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10515
10516 backend stats_auth
10517 stats enable
10518 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10519 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10520 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10521 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10522
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010523 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10524 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10525 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010526
10527
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010528stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10529 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010531 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010532 Arguments :
10533 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10534
10535 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10536
10537 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10538 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10539 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10540 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10541 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10542 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10543
10544 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10545 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10546 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010547 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010548
10549 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10550 report using "stats scope".
10551
10552 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10553 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10554 unobvious parameters.
10555
10556 Example :
10557 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10558 backend public_www
10559 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10560 stats enable
10561 stats hide-version
10562 stats scope .
10563 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010564 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010565 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10566 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10567
10568 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10569 backend private_monitoring
10570 stats enable
10571 stats uri /admin?stats
10572 stats refresh 5s
10573
10574 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10575
10576
10577stats enable
10578 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010580 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010581 Arguments : none
10582
10583 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10584 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10585 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10586 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10587 - stats auth : no authentication
10588 - stats scope : no restriction
10589
10590 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10591 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10592 unobvious parameters.
10593
10594 Example :
10595 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10596 backend public_www
10597 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10598 stats enable
10599 stats hide-version
10600 stats scope .
10601 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010602 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010603 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10604 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10605
10606 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10607 backend private_monitoring
10608 stats enable
10609 stats uri /admin?stats
10610 stats refresh 5s
10611
10612 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10613
10614
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010615stats hide-version
10616 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010618 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010619 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010620
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010621 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10622 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10623 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10624 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10625 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10626 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010627
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010628 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10629 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10630 unobvious parameters.
10631
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010632 Example :
10633 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10634 backend public_www
10635 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010636 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010637 stats hide-version
10638 stats scope .
10639 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010640 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010641 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10642 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010643
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010644 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10645 backend private_monitoring
10646 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010647 stats uri /admin?stats
10648 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010649
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010650 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010651
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010652
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010653stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10654 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10655 Access control for statistics
10656
10657 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10658 no | no | yes | yes
10659
10660 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10661 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10662 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10663 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10664 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10665 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10666
10667 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10668 instance.
10669
10670 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10671 about ACL usage.
10672
10673
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010674stats realm <realm>
10675 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010677 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010678 Arguments :
10679 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10680 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10681 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10682
10683 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10684 using a backslash ('\').
10685
10686 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10687 only related to authentication.
10688
10689 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10690 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10691 unobvious parameters.
10692
10693 Example :
10694 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10695 backend public_www
10696 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10697 stats enable
10698 stats hide-version
10699 stats scope .
10700 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010701 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010702 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10703 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10704
10705 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10706 backend private_monitoring
10707 stats enable
10708 stats uri /admin?stats
10709 stats refresh 5s
10710
10711 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10712
10713
10714stats refresh <delay>
10715 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010717 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010718 Arguments :
10719 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10720 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10721 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10722 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10723 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10724 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10725
10726 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10727 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10728 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010729 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010730
10731 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10732 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10733 unobvious parameters.
10734
10735 Example :
10736 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10737 backend public_www
10738 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10739 stats enable
10740 stats hide-version
10741 stats scope .
10742 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010743 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010744 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10745 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10746
10747 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10748 backend private_monitoring
10749 stats enable
10750 stats uri /admin?stats
10751 stats refresh 5s
10752
10753 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10754
10755
10756stats scope { <name> | "." }
10757 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010759 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010760 Arguments :
10761 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10762 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10763 section in which the statement appears.
10764
10765 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10766 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10767 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10768 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10769 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10770 exists.
10771
10772 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10773 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10774 unobvious parameters.
10775
10776 Example :
10777 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10778 backend public_www
10779 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10780 stats enable
10781 stats hide-version
10782 stats scope .
10783 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010784 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010785 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10786 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10787
10788 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10789 backend private_monitoring
10790 stats enable
10791 stats uri /admin?stats
10792 stats refresh 5s
10793
10794 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10795
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010796
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010797stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010798 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010800 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010801
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010802 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010803 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10804
10805 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10806 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10807
10808 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10809 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010810 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010811
10812 Example :
10813 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10814 backend private_monitoring
10815 stats enable
10816 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10817 stats uri /admin?stats
10818 stats refresh 5s
10819
10820 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10821 global section.
10822
10823
10824stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010825 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10827 yes | yes | yes | yes
10828 Arguments : none
10829
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010830 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010831 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10832 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10833 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10834 - IP (socket, server)
10835 - cookie (backend, server)
10836
10837 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10838 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010839 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010840
10841 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10842
10843
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010844stats show-modules
10845 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10847 yes | yes | yes | yes
10848 Arguments : none
10849
10850 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10851 values as a tooltip.
10852
10853 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10854 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10855 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10856
10857 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10858
10859
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010860stats show-node [ <name> ]
10861 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010863 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010864 Arguments:
10865 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10866 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10867
10868 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10869 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010870 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010871
10872 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10873 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10874 unobvious parameters.
10875
10876 Example:
10877 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10878 backend private_monitoring
10879 stats enable
10880 stats show-node Europe-1
10881 stats uri /admin?stats
10882 stats refresh 5s
10883
10884 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10885 section.
10886
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010887
10888stats uri <prefix>
10889 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010891 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010892 Arguments :
10893 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10894 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10895 query string.
10896
10897 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10898 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10899 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10900 possible to reach it in the application.
10901
10902 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010903 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010904 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10905 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10906 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10907 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10908
10909 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10910 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10911 an address or a port to statistics only.
10912
10913 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10914 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10915 unobvious parameters.
10916
10917 Example :
10918 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10919 backend public_www
10920 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10921 stats enable
10922 stats hide-version
10923 stats scope .
10924 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010925 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010926 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10927 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10928
10929 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10930 backend private_monitoring
10931 stats enable
10932 stats uri /admin?stats
10933 stats refresh 5s
10934
10935 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10936
10937
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010938stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10939 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010941 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010942
10943 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010944 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010945 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010946 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010947 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10948
10949 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10950 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10951 the "stick-table" statement.
10952
10953 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10954 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10955 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10956 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10957 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10958
10959 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10960 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10961 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10962 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10963 transformation rules.
10964
10965 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10966 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10967 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10968 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10969 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10970 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10971 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10972
10973 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10974 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10975 ACL based conditions.
10976
10977 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10978 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10979 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10980 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10981
10982 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10983 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10984 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10985 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10986
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010987 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10988 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010989 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010990
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010991 Example :
10992 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10993 # last 30 minutes
10994 backend pop
10995 mode tcp
10996 balance roundrobin
10997 stick store-request src
10998 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10999 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11000 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11001
11002 backend smtp
11003 mode tcp
11004 balance roundrobin
11005 stick match src table pop
11006 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11007 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11008
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011009 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011010 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011011
11012
11013stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11014 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11016 no | no | yes | yes
11017
11018 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11019 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11020 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11021 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11022
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011023 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11024 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011025 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011026
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011027 Examples :
11028 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011029 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011030
11031 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11032 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11033 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11034
11035
11036 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11037 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11038 backend http
11039 mode http
11040 balance roundrobin
11041 stick on src table https
11042 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11043 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11044 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11045
11046 backend https
11047 mode tcp
11048 balance roundrobin
11049 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11050 stick on src
11051 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11052 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11053
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011054 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011055
11056
11057stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11058 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11060 no | no | yes | yes
11061
11062 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011063 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011064 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011065 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011066 server is selected.
11067
11068 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11069 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11070 the "stick-table" statement.
11071
11072 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11073 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11074 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11075 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11076 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11077 address.
11078
11079 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11080 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11081 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11082 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11083 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11084 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11085 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11086 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11087 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11088 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11089
11090 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11091 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11092 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11093 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11094 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11095 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11096 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11097
11098 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11099 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11100 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11101 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11102
11103 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11104 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11105 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11106 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11107 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11108 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011109 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11110 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11111 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11112 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11113 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11114 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011115
11116 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11117 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11118 the request.
11119
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011120 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11121 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011122 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011123
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011124 Example :
11125 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11126 # last 30 minutes
11127 backend pop
11128 mode tcp
11129 balance roundrobin
11130 stick store-request src
11131 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11132 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11133 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11134
11135 backend smtp
11136 mode tcp
11137 balance roundrobin
11138 stick match src table pop
11139 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11140 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11141
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011142 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011143 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011144
11145
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011146stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011147 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011148 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011149 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011151 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011152
11153 Arguments :
11154 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11155 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11156 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11157 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11158
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011159 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11160 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11161 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11162 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11163
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011164 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11165 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11166 instance.
11167
11168 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11169 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11170 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11171 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11172 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11173 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011174 to 32 characters.
11175
11176 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11177 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11178 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011179 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011180 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11181 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011182
11183 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011184 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11185 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011186 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11187 increase.
11188
11189 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011190 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11191 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11192 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011193
11194 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
11195 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
11196 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11197 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011198 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011199 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11200 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11201 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11202 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11203 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11204 parameter (see below).
11205
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011206 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11207 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11208 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11209 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11210 soft restart.
11211
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011212 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11213 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011214
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011215 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11216 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11217 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11218 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011219 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011220 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011221 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11222 if not expiration delay is specified.
11223
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011224 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11225 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11226 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11227 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11228 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11229 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11230 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11231 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11232 token.
11233
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011234 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11235 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11236 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11237 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011238 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11239 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11240 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11241 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11242 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11243 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11244 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11245 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11246 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11247 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11248 types and their arguments.
11249
11250 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11251 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11252 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11253 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11254
11255 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11256 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11257 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011258 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011259
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011260 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11261 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11262 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011263 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011264 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011265 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011266
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011267 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11268 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11269 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11270 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11271
11272 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11273 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11274 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11275 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11276 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11277 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11278
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011279 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11280 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11281 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11282 they were received.
11283
11284 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11285 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11286 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11287 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11288 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11289
11290 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11291 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11292 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11293 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11294 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11295
11296 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11297 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11298 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11299
11300 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11301 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11302 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11303 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11304 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11305
11306 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11307 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11308 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11309 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11310 the client side.
11311
11312 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11313 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11314 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11315 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11316 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11317 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11318 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11319
11320 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11321 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11322 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11323 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11324 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11325 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011326 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011327
11328 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11329 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11330 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11331 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11332 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11333 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11334
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011335 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11336 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11337 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11338 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11339 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11340
11341 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11342 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11343 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11344 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11345 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11346 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11347
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011348 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011349 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011350 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11351 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11352
11353 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11354 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11355 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11356 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11357 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11358 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11359 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11360 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11361 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11362 recommended for better fairness.
11363
11364 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011365 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011366 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11367 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11368
11369 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11370 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11371 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11372 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11373 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11374 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11375 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11376 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11377 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11378 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011379
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011380 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11381 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011382 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11383 reference it.
11384
11385 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11386 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011387 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11388 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11389 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011390
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011391 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11392 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11393 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11394 something that can be ignored.
11395
11396 Example:
11397 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11398 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11399 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11400 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11401
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011402 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011403 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011404
11405
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011406stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011407 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11409 no | no | yes | yes
11410
11411 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011412 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011413 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011414 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011415 server is selected.
11416
11417 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11418 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11419 the "stick-table" statement.
11420
11421 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11422 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11423 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11424 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11425
11426 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11427 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11428 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11429 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11430 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11431 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011432 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011433 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11434 rules.
11435
11436 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11437 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11438 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11439 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11440 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11441 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11442 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11443
11444 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11445 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11446 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11447 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11448
11449 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11450 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11451 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11452 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11453 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11454 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011455 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11456 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11457 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11458 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11459 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11460 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11461 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11462 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11463 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011464
11465 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11466
11467 Example :
11468 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11469 backend https
11470 mode tcp
11471 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011472 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011473 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011474
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011475 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11476 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11477
11478 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11479 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11480 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11481
11482 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11483 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011484
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011485 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11486 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11487 # at offset 44.
11488
11489 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11490 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11491
11492 # Learn on response if server hello.
11493 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011494
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011495 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11496 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11497
11498 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11499 extraction.
11500
11501
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011502tcp-check comment <string>
11503 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11504 it fails.
11505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11506 yes | no | yes | yes
11507
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011508 Arguments :
11509 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11510 rule fails.
11511
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011512 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11513 user-friendly error reporting.
11514
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011515 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11516 "tcp-check expect".
11517
11518
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011519tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11520 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011521 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011522 Opens a new connection
11523 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011524 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011525
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011526 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011527 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11528
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011529 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011530 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011531
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011532 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011533 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11534 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011535 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011536
11537 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011538
11539 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11540
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011541 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11542
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011543 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11544
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011545 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11546
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011547 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11548 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11549 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11550 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11551
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011552 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11553 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11554 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11555 haproxy -vv.
11556
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011557 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011558
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011559 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11560 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11561 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11562
11563 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11564 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11565 of the sequence.
11566
11567 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11568 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11569 do.
11570
11571 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11572 unset-var or comment rules.
11573
11574 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011575 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11576 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11577 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11578 option tcp-check
11579 tcp-check connect
11580 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11581 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11582 tcp-check send \r\n
11583 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11584 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11585 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11586 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11587 tcp-check send \r\n
11588 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11589 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11590
11591 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11592 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011593 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011594 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11595 tcp-check connect port 143
11596 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11597 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11598
11599 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11600
11601
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011602tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011603 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011604 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011605 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011606 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011607 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011608 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011609
11610 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011611 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11612
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011613 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11614 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11615 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11616 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11617 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11618 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11619 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11620 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11621 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11622 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11623
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011624 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011625 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11626 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011627 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11628 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11629 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11630
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011631 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11632 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11633 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011634 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11635 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011636 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11637 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011638 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11639 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011640 By default "L7OK" is used.
11641
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011642 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11643 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011644 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11645 supported :
11646 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11647 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011648 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11649 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11650 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11651 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11652 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011653
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011654 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011655 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011656 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11657 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11658 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11659 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011660 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11661
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011662 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11663 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11664 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11665 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11666
11667 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11668 informational message reported in logs if an error
11669 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11670 log-format string.
11671
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011672 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11673 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11674 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11675 followed by some converters.
11676
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011677 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11678 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11679 with the usual backslash ('\').
11680 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011681 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011682 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11683 used upper or lower case.
11684
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011685 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11686
11687 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11688 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11689 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11690 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11691 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11692 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11693 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11694 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11695
11696 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11697 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11698 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11699 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11700 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11701 expression.
11702
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011703 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11704 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11705 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11706 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11707 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11708 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11709
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011710 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11711 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11712 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11713 this exact hexadecimal string.
11714 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11715
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011716 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11717 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11718 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11719 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11720 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11721 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11722 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11723 size.
11724
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011725 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11726 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11727 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11728 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11729 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11730 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11731 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11732 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11733 in a binary string before matching the response's
11734 buffer.
11735
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011736 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011737 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011738 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11739 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11740 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11741 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11742 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11743 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11744 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11745 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11746 the null character.
11747
11748 Examples :
11749 # perform a POP check
11750 option tcp-check
11751 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11752
11753 # perform an IMAP check
11754 option tcp-check
11755 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11756
11757 # look for the redis master server
11758 option tcp-check
11759 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011760 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011761 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11762 tcp-check expect string role:master
11763 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11764 tcp-check expect string +OK
11765
11766
11767 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011768 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011769
11770
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011771tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11772tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11773 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11774 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011775 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011776 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011777
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011778 Arguments :
11779 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11780
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011781 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11782 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011783
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011784 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11785 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011786
11787 Examples :
11788 # look for the redis master server
11789 option tcp-check
11790 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11791 tcp-check expect string role:master
11792
11793 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011794 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011795
11796
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011797tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11798tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11799 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11800 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011801 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011802 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011803
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011804 Arguments :
11805 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011806
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011807 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11808 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011809
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011810 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11811 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11812 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011813
11814 Examples :
11815 # redis check in binary
11816 option tcp-check
11817 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11818 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11819
11820
11821 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011822 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011823
11824
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011825tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011826 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011827 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011828 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011829
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011830 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011831 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11832 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11833 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11834 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11835 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11836 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11837 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11838 and '-'.
11839
11840 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11841
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011842 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011843 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11844
11845
11846tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011847 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011848 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011849 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011850
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011851 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011852 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11853 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11854 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11855 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11856 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11857 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11858 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11859 and '-'.
11860
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011861 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011862 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11863
11864
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011865tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11866 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11868 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011869 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011870 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11871 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011872
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011873 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011874
11875 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11876 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011877 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11878 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11879 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11880 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11881 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11882 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011883
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011884 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11885 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11886 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11887 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011888
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011889 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011890 - accept :
11891 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11892 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11893 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011894
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011895 - reject :
11896 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11897 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11898 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11899 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11900 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11901 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11902 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11903 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11904 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11905 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11906 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011907 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011908
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011909 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11910 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11911 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11912 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11913 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11914 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11915 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11916 hosts.
11917
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011918 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11919 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11920 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11921 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11922 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11923 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11924 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11925 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11926
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011927 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11928 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11929 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11930 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11931 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11932 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11933 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11934 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11935 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011936 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11937 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011938
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011939 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011940 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011941 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11942 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11943 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011944 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011945 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011946 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11947 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11948 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11949 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11950 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11951 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11952 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011953
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011954 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011955 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011956 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011957 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011958 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11959 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11960 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011961
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011962 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11963 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11964 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11965 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011966
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011967 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11968 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11969 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11970 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11971 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011972 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11973 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11974 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11975 layer7 information is extracted.
11976
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011977 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11978 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11979 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11980 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11981 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011982
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011983 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11984 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11985 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11986 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11987
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011988 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11989 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11990 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11991 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11992
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011993 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11994 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11995 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11996 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11997 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011998
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011999 - set-src <expr> :
12000 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12001 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12002 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012003 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012004
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012005 Arguments:
12006 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12007 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012008
12009 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012010 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12011
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012012 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12013 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012014
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012015 - set-src-port <expr> :
12016 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12017 expression.
12018
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012019 Arguments:
12020 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12021 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012022
12023 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012024 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12025
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012026 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12027 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12028 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012029
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012030 - set-dst <expr> :
12031 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12032 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12033 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12034 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12035 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12036
12037 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12038 followed by some converters.
12039
12040 Example:
12041
12042 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12043 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12044
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012045 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12046 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12047
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012048 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12049 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12050 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12051 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12052
12053
12054 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12055 followed by some converters.
12056
12057 Example:
12058
12059 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12060
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012061 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12062 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12063 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12064
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012065 - "silent-drop" :
12066 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012067 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012068 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12069 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12070 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12071 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12072 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012073 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12074 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012075 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12076 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012077 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012078 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12079 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12080 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12081 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12082
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012083 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12084 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12085 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012086
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012087 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12088 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12089 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012090
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012091 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012092 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012093 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012094
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012095 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12096 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12097 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012098
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012099 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012100 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12101 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012102
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012103 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12104
12105 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12106
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012107 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12108
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012109 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012110
12111
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012112tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12113 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012115 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012116 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012117 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12118 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012119
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012120 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012121
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012122 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012123 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12124 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012125 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12126 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012127
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012128 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12129 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12130 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12131 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012132 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
12133 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
12134 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12135 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12136 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12137 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012138 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012139 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012140
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012141 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12142 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12143 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12144 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012145
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012146 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012147 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012148 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012149 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12150 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012151 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012152 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012153 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012154 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012155 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012156 - set-dst <expr>
12157 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012158 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012159 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012160 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012161 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012162 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012163 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012164
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012165 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12166 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012167 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12168 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012169
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012170 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12171 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12172 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12173 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12174 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12175 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012176
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012177 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012178 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12179 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012180
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012181 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12182 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12183 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12184 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12185 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12186 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12187
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012188 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012189 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12190 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12191 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12192 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12193 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12194 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12195 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12196 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12197 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12198 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012199
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012200 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012201 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12202 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12203 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012204
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012205 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12206 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12207
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012208 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012209 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12210 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012211
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012212 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12213 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012214 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012215 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12216 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012217 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012218 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012219 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012220 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12221 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012222 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012223 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12224 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012225
12226 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12227 followed by some converters.
12228
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012229 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a conntection upgrade. Only HTTP
12230 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12231 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12232 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12233 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12234 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12235 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +050012236 warning. These directives will be conditionaly evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012237 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12238 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12239
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012240 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12241
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012242 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12243 <var-name>.
12244
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012245 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12246 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12247 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12248 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12249 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12250
12251 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12252 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12253 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12254 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12255 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12256 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12257 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12258 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12259 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12260 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12261 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12262
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012263 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12264 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12265 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12266 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12267 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12268
12269 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12270
12271 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12272
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012273 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12274 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12275 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12276 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12277 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12278 evaluated.
12279
12280 Example:
12281 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12282
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012283 Example:
12284
12285 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012286 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012287
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012288 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012289 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012290 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012291 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12292 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012293 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012294 tcp-request content reject
12295
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012296 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12297 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12298 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12299 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12300 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12301 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12302 ...
12303 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12304
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012305 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012306 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12307 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12308 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012309 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012310
12311 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12312 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12313 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012314 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012315 tcp-request content reject
12316
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012317 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012318 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012319 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012320 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012321 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12322 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012323
12324 Example:
12325 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12326 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012327 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012328
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012329 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012330 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012331
12332 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012333 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012334 # protecting all our sites
12335 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012336 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12337 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012338 ...
12339 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12340
12341 backend http_dynamic
12342 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012343 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012344 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012345 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012346 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012347 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012348 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012349
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012350 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012351
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012352 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12353 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012354
12355
12356tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12357 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012359 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012360 Arguments :
12361 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12362 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12363 as explained at the top of this document.
12364
12365 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
12366 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12367 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12368 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12369 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12370
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012371 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12372 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12373 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12374 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12375
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012376 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
12377 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012378 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012379 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012380 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
12381 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12382 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12383 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012384
12385 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12386 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12387 it pass through unaffected.
12388
12389 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12390 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12391 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012392 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012393 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12394 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012395 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12396 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12397 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012398
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012399 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012400 "timeout client".
12401
12402
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012403tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12404 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12406 no | no | yes | yes
12407 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012408 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12409 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012410
12411 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12412
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012413 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012414 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12415 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012416 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12417 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012418
12419 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12420
12421 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12422 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12423 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12424 inserted.
12425
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012426 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012427 - accept :
12428 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12429 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12430 the rules evaluation.
12431
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012432 - close :
12433 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12434 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12435 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12436 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12437 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12438 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012439 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012440 protocols.
12441
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012442 - reject :
12443 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12444 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012445 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012446
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012447 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12448 Sets a variable.
12449
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012450 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12451 Unsets a variable.
12452
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012453 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12454 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12455 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12456 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12457
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012458 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12459 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12460 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12461 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12462
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012463 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12464 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12465 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12466 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12467 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012468
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012469 - "silent-drop" :
12470 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012471 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012472 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12473 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12474 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12475 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12476 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012477 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12478 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012479 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12480 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012481 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012482 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12483 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12484 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12485 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12486
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012487 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12488 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12489
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012490 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12491 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12492 for changing the default action to a reject.
12493
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012494 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12495 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12496 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12497 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012498 period.
12499
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012500 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12501 declared inline.
12502
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012503 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12504 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012505 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012506 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12507 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012508 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012509 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012510 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012511 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12512 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012513 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012514 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12515 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012516
12517 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12518 followed by some converters.
12519
12520 Example:
12521
12522 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12523
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012524 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12525 <var-name>.
12526
12527 Example:
12528
12529 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12530
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012531 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12532 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12533 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12534 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12535 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12536
12537 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12538
12539 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12540
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012541 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12542
12543 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12544
12545
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012546tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12547 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12549 no | yes | yes | no
12550 Arguments :
12551 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12552 below.
12553
12554 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12555
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012556 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012557 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12558 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12559 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12560 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12561 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12562 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12563 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012564 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012565 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12566 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12567 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12568 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12569 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12570 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12571 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12572 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12573 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12574 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12575 instead.
12576
12577 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12578 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12579 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12580 rules which may be inserted.
12581
12582 Several types of actions are supported :
12583 - accept : the request is accepted
12584 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12585 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12586 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012587 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012588 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012589 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012590 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012591 - silent-drop
12592
12593 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12594 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12595 sections for a complete description.
12596
12597 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12598 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12599 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12600
12601 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12602 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12603 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12604 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12605 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12606
12607 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12608 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12609
12610 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12611 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12612 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12613
12614 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12615 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12616 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12617
12618 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12619 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12620 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12621
12622 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12623 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12624 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12625
12626 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12627
12628 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12629
12630
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012631tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12632 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12634 no | no | yes | yes
12635 Arguments :
12636 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12637 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12638 as explained at the top of this document.
12639
12640 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12641
12642
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012643timeout check <timeout>
12644 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12645 established.
12646
12647 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12648 yes | no | yes | yes
12649 Arguments:
12650 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12651 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12652 as explained at the top of this document.
12653
12654 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12655 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012656 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012657 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012658 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12659 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12660 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012661
12662 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12663 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12664
12665 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12666 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012667 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012668
12669 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12670 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12671 forget about it.
12672
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012673 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12674 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012675
12676
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012677timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012678 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12680 yes | yes | yes | no
12681 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012682 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012683 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12684 as explained at the top of this document.
12685
12686 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12687 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12688 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012689 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12690 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12691 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12692 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012693 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12694 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12695 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012696 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012697 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012698 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12699 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012700 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12701 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012702
12703 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12704 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12705 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12706 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012707 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012708 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12709
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012710 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012711
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012712 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012713
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012714
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012715timeout client-fin <timeout>
12716 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12718 yes | yes | yes | no
12719 Arguments :
12720 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12721 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12722 as explained at the top of this document.
12723
12724 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12725 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12726 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12727 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12728 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12729 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12730 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012731 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12732 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12733 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012734
12735 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12736 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12737 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12738
12739 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12740
12741
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012742timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012743 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12745 yes | no | yes | yes
12746 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012747 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012748 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12749 as explained at the top of this document.
12750
12751 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012752 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012753 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012754 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012755 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12756 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012757
12758 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12759 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12760 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12761 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012762 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012763 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12764
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012765 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012766
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012767
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012768timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12769 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12771 yes | yes | yes | yes
12772 Arguments :
12773 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12774 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12775 as explained at the top of this document.
12776
12777 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12778 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12779 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12780 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12781 once the request has started to present itself.
12782
12783 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12784 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12785 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12786 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12787 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12788
12789 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12790 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12791 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12792 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12793
12794 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12795 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012796 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012797 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12798 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012799 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012800
12801 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12802 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12803 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12804 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12805
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012806 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12807 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012808 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12809
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012810 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12811
12812
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012813timeout http-request <timeout>
12814 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012816 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012817 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012818 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012819 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12820 as explained at the top of this document.
12821
12822 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12823 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12824 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12825 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12826 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12827 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12828 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012829 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12830 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12831 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12832 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012833 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012834 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12835 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012836
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012837 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12838 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12839 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12840 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12841 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012842 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012843
12844 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12845 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012846 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012847 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12848 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12849
12850 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012851 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12852 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12853 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012854
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012855 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012856 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012857
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012858
12859timeout queue <timeout>
12860 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12862 yes | no | yes | yes
12863 Arguments :
12864 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12865 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12866 as explained at the top of this document.
12867
12868 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12869 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12870 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12871 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12872 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12873
12874 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12875 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12876 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12877 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12878
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012879 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012880
12881
12882timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012883 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12885 yes | no | yes | yes
12886 Arguments :
12887 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12888 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12889 as explained at the top of this document.
12890
12891 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12892 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12893 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12894 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12895 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12896 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12897 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12898
12899 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12900 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12901 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12902 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12903 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012904 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012905 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012906 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12907 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012908 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12909 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012910
12911 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12912 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12913 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12914 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012915 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012916 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12917
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012918 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012919
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012920
12921timeout server-fin <timeout>
12922 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12924 yes | no | yes | yes
12925 Arguments :
12926 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12927 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12928 as explained at the top of this document.
12929
12930 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12931 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12932 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12933 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12934 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12935 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12936 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12937 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12938 situations, it should not be needed.
12939
12940 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12941 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12942 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12943
12944 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12945
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012946
12947timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012948 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12950 yes | yes | yes | yes
12951 Arguments :
12952 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12953 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12954 as explained at the top of this document.
12955
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012956 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12957 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12958 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012959
12960 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12961 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12962 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12963 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012964 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012965
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012966 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012967
12968
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012969timeout tunnel <timeout>
12970 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12972 yes | no | yes | yes
12973 Arguments :
12974 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12975 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12976 as explained at the top of this document.
12977
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012978 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012979 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12980 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12981 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012982 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12983 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012984 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12985 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12986 specified.
12987
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012988 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12989 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12990 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12991 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12992 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12993 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12994 state.
12995
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012996 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12997 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12998 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12999 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013000 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013001
13002 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13003 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13004 forget about it.
13005
13006 Example :
13007 defaults http
13008 option http-server-close
13009 timeout connect 5s
13010 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013011 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013012 timeout server 30s
13013 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13014
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013015 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013016
13017
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013018transparent (deprecated)
13019 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013021 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013022 Arguments : none
13023
13024 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13025 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13026 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13027 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13028 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13029 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13030 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13031 appropriate server.
13032
13033 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13034
13035 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13036 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13037
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013038 See also: "option transparent"
13039
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013040unique-id-format <string>
13041 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13043 yes | yes | yes | no
13044 Arguments :
13045 <string> is a log-format string.
13046
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013047 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13048 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13049 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13050 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013051
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013052 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
13053 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
13054 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13055 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13056 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13057 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13058 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13059 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013060
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013061 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13062 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013063
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013064 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013065
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013066 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013067
13068 will generate:
13069
13070 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13071
13072 See also: "unique-id-header"
13073
13074unique-id-header <name>
13075 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13077 yes | yes | yes | no
13078 Arguments :
13079 <name> is the name of the header.
13080
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013081 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13082 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013083
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013084 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013085
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013086 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013087 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13088
13089 will generate:
13090
13091 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13092
13093 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013094
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013095use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013096 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13098 no | yes | yes | no
13099 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013100 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13101 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013102
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013103 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13104 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013105
13106 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13107 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13108 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013109 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013110 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013111 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13112 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013113
13114 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13115 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13116 assign the backend.
13117
13118 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13119 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13120 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13121 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13122 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13123 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13124
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013125 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013126 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013127 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13128 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13129 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13130
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013131 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13132 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13133 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13134 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13135 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13136 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13137 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13138 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13139 cannot be forced from the request.
13140
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013141 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013142 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13143 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13144
13145 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13146 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013147
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013148use-fcgi-app <name>
13149 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13151 no | no | yes | yes
13152 Arguments :
13153 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13154
13155 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013156
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013157use-server <server> if <condition>
13158use-server <server> unless <condition>
13159 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13161 no | no | yes | yes
13162 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013163 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13164 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013165
13166 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13167
13168 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13169 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13170 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13171
13172 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13173 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13174 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13175 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13176 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13177 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13178 matches will assign the server.
13179
13180 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13181 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13182 with the next rules until one matches.
13183
13184 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13185 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13186 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13187 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13188
13189 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13190 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13191 stripped.
13192
13193 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13194 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013195 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
13196 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
13197 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013198
13199 Example :
13200 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
13201 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
13202 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
13203 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013204 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013205 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013206 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013207 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13208 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13209
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013210 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13211 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13212 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13213 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013214 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013215 and we fall back to load balancing.
13216
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013217 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013218
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013219
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132205. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013221--------------------------
13222
13223The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13224depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13225settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13226written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13227described in this section.
13228
13229
132305.1. Bind options
13231-----------------
13232
13233The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13234as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13235no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13236parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13237while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13238provided immediately after the setting name.
13239
13240The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13241
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013242accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13243 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13244 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13245 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13246 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13247 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13248 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13249 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13250 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13251 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013252 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13253 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13254 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013255
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013256accept-proxy
13257 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013258 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13259 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013260 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13261 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13262 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13263 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013264 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013265 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13266 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013267 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13268 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013269
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013270allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013271 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013272 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013273 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013274 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13275 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013276
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013277alpn <protocols>
13278 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13279 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13280 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013281 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013282 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013283 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13284 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13285 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13286 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13287 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13288 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13289 preference, like below :
13290
13291 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013292
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013293backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013294 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013295 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13296
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013297curves <curves>
13298 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13299 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13300 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13301 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13302 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13303 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13304
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013305ecdhe <named curve>
13306 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013307 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13308 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013309
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013310ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013311 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13312 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13313 client's certificate.
13314
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013315ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13316 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13317 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13318 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13319 error is ignored.
13320
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013321ca-sign-file <cafile>
13322 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13323 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13324 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13325 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13326 'generate-certificates' for details.
13327
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013328ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013329 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13330 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13331 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13332 'generate-certificates' for details.
13333
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013334ca-verify-file <cafile>
13335 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13336 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13337 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13338 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13339 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13340
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013341ciphers <ciphers>
13342 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13343 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013344 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013345 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013346 information and recommendations see e.g.
13347 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13348 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13349 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13350
13351ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13352 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13353 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13354 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13355 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013356 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13357 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013358
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013359crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013360 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13361 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13362 to verify client's certificate.
13363
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013364crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013365 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13366 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13367 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13368 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13369 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013370 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13371 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013372
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013373 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13374 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13375
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013376 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13377 are loaded.
13378
13379 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013380 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13381 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13382 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13383 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13384 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13385 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13386 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013387 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013388
13389 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13390 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13391 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13392 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013393 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13394 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013395
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013396 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013397
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013398 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013399 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013400 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13401 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013402 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13403 clients).
13404
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013405 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
13406 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13407 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13408 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13409 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13410 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13411 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13412 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13413 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13414 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13415 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13416 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13417 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13418
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013419 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
13420 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13421 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13422 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13423 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13424
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013425 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13426 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13427 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13428 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013429
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013430 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13431 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13432 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013433
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013434crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013435 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013436 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013437 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013438 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013439
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013440crt-list <file>
13441 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013442 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13443 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013444
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013445 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13446
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013447 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13448 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13449 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13450 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13451 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013452
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013453 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013454 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13455 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13456 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13457 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13458 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013459 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13460 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13461 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013462
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013463 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13464 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13465 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013466
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013467 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13468
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013469 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
13470 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
13471 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13472 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13473 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13474 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13475 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13476 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013477
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013478 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013479 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013480 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013481 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013482 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013483 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013484
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013485defer-accept
13486 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13487 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13488 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013489 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013490 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13491 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13492 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13493 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13494 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13495 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13496 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13497
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013498expose-fd listeners
13499 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13500 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013501 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13502 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013503 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013504
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013505force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013506 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013507 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013508 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013509 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013510
13511force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013512 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013513 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013514 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013515
13516force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013517 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013518 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013519 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013520
13521force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013522 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013523 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013524 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013525
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013526force-tlsv13
13527 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13528 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013529 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013530
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013531generate-certificates
13532 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13533 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13534 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13535 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13536 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13537 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13538 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13539 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13540 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13541 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13542 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13543
13544 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13545 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013546 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013547 certificate is used many times.
13548
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013549gid <gid>
13550 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13551 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13552 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13553 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13554 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13555
13556group <group>
13557 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13558 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13559 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13560 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13561 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13562
13563id <id>
13564 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13565 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13566 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13567 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13568
13569interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013570 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13571 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13572 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13573 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13574 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13575 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013576 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13577 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13578 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13579 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13580 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13581 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013582
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013583level <level>
13584 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13585 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13586 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013587 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013588 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13589 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13590 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013591 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013592 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013593 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013594 all counters).
13595
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013596severity-output <format>
13597 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13598 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13599 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13600 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13601 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13602 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13603 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13604 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13605 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13606 rfc5424 convention.
13607
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013608maxconn <maxconn>
13609 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13610 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13611 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13612 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13613 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13614 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13615 eat all memory.
13616
13617mode <mode>
13618 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13619 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13620 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13621 UNIX sockets.
13622
13623mss <maxseg>
13624 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13625 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13626 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13627 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13628 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13629 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13630 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13631 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13632 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13633 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13634 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13635
13636name <name>
13637 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13638 page.
13639
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013640namespace <name>
13641 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13642 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13643 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13644 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13645
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013646nice <nice>
13647 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13648 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13649 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13650 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13651 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13652 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13653 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13654 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13655 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13656 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13657 one for an RDP socket.
13658
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013659no-ca-names
13660 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13661 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013662 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013663
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013664no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013665 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013666 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013667 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013668 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013669 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13670 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013671
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013672no-tls-tickets
13673 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13674 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13675 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013676 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13677 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013678 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13679 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13680 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013681
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013682no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013683 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013684 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013685 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013686 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013687 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13688 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013689
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013690no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013691 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013692 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013693 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013694 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013695 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13696 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013697
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013698no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013699 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013700 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013701 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013702 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013703 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13704 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013705
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013706no-tlsv13
13707 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13708 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13709 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13710 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013711 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13712 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013713
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013714npn <protocols>
13715 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13716 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13717 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013718 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013719 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013720 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13721 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13722 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13723 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13724 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013725
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013726prefer-client-ciphers
13727 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13728 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13729 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013730 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13731 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13732 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013733
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013734process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013735 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013736 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013737 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013738 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13739 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13740 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13741 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013742 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013743 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13744 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13745 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13746 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13747 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013748
13749 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13750
13751 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13752 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13753 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13754 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13755 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13756 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13757 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13758 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013759
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013760proto <name>
13761 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13762 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13763 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013764 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13765 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13766
13767 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13768 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13769 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13770 also reported (flag=HTX).
13771
13772 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13773 a bind line :
13774
13775 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13776 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13777 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13778
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013779 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013780 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013781 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013782 h2" on the bind line.
13783
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013784ssl
13785 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013786 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013787 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13788 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013789 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13790 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013791
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013792ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13793 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013794 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13795 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13796 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013797 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13798
13799ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013800 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13801 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13802 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13803 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013804
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013805strict-sni
13806 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13807 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13808 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13809 See the "crt" option for more information.
13810
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013811tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013812 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013813 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13814 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013815 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013816 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13817 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13818 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13819 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13820 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13821 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13822 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13823
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013824tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013825 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013826 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13827 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13828 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13829 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13830 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13831 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13832 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013833 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13834 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13835 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013836
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013837tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13838 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013839 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13840 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13841 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13842 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13843 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13844 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13845 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13846 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13847 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13848 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013849 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13850 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13851
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013852transparent
13853 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13854 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13855 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13856 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13857 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13858 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13859 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13860 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13861 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13862 so check for support with your vendor.
13863
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013864v4v6
13865 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13866 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13867 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13868 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013869 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013870
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013871v6only
13872 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13873 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13874 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013875 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13876 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013877
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013878uid <uid>
13879 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13880 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13881 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13882 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13883 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13884
13885user <user>
13886 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13887 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13888 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13889 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13890 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13891
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013892verify [none|optional|required]
13893 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13894 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13895 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13896 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13897 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013898 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13899 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13900 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13901 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013902
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200139035.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013904------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013905
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013906The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13907which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13908arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13909settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13910after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13911Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13912address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013913
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013914 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013915 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013916
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013917Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13918keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13919
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013920The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013921
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013922addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013923 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013924 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13925 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13926 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13927 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13928 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013929
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013930agent-check
13931 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013932 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013933 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13934 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13935 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013936
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013937 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013938 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013939 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13940 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13941 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013942
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013943 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13944 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13945 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13946 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13947 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013948
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013949 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013950 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013951
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013952 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13953 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13954 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013955
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013956 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13957 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13958 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013959
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013960 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013961 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13962 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13963 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13964 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013965 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013966 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013967
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013968 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13969 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013970
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013971 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13972 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13973 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13974 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13975 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13976 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13977 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13978 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13979 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013980
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013981 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13982 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013983 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13984 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13985 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013986 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013987
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013988 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013989 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013990
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013991agent-send <string>
13992 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13993 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13994 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13995 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13996 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13997
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013998agent-inter <delay>
13999 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14000 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14001
14002 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14003 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14004 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14005 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14006 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14007 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14008 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14009 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14010 of backends use the same servers.
14011
14012 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14013
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014014agent-addr <addr>
14015 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14016
14017 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
14018 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
14019 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14020 hostname, it will be resolved.
14021
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014022agent-port <port>
14023 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14024
14025 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14026
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014027allow-0rtt
14028 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014029 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14030 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014031
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014032alpn <protocols>
14033 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14034 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14035 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014036 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014037 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14038 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14039 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14040 now obsolete NPN extension.
14041 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14042 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14043
14044 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14045
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014046backup
14047 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14048 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14049 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14050 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014051 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14052 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014053
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014054ca-file <cafile>
14055 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14056 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14057 server's certificate.
14058
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014059check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014060 This option enables health checks on a server:
14061 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14062 considered available.
14063 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14064 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14065 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14066 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14067 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14068 set.
14069 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14070 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14071 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14072 exchanges succeed.
14073
14074 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14075 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14076 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14077 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14078 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014079 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014080 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14081
14082 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14083 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14084
14085 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14086 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14087
14088 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14089 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14090 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14091 available.
14092
14093 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14094 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14095 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14096
14097 Example:
14098 # simple tcp check
14099 backend foo
14100 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14101 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14102 backend foo
14103 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14104 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14105 backend foo
14106 option tcp-check
14107 tcp-check connect
14108 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014109
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014110check-send-proxy
14111 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14112 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14113 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14114 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14115 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14116 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14117 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14118
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014119check-alpn <protocols>
14120 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14121 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14122 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14123
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014124check-proto <name>
14125 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14126 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14127 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014128 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14129 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14130
14131 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14132 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14133 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14134 also reported (flag=HTX).
14135
14136 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14137 directive on a server line:
14138
14139 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14140 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14141 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14142 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14143
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014144 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014145 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14146 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14147
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014148check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014149 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014150 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14151 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014152
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014153check-ssl
14154 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14155 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14156 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14157 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014158 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014159 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14160 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014161 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014162 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14163 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014164
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014165check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014166 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014167 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14168 for normal traffic.
14169
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014170ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014171 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14172 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14173 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014174 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14175 information and recommendations see e.g.
14176 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14177 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14178 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014179
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014180ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14181 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14182 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14183 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14184 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014185 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14186 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14187 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014188
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014189cookie <value>
14190 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14191 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14192 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14193 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14194 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14195 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14196 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14197
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014198crl-file <crlfile>
14199 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14200 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14201 to verify server's certificate.
14202
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014203crt <cert>
14204 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14205 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14206 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14207 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14208 certificate request.
14209
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014210disabled
14211 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14212 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14213 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14214 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14215 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014216 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014217
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014218enabled
14219 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14220 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14221 default value.
14222 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14223 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014224
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014225error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014226 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14227 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14228 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014229
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014230 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014231
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014232fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014233 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14234 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14235 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14236
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014237force-sslv3
14238 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14239 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014240 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014241 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014242
14243force-tlsv10
14244 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014245 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014246 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014247
14248force-tlsv11
14249 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014250 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014251 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014252
14253force-tlsv12
14254 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014255 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014256 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014257
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014258force-tlsv13
14259 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14260 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014261 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014263id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014264 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14265 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14266 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014267
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014268init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14269 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14270 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014271 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014272 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14273 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14274 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14275 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14276 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14277 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14278 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14279 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14280 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014281 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014282 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14283 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14284 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14285 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14286 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14287 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014288 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014289
14290 Example:
14291 defaults
14292 # never fail on address resolution
14293 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14294
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014295inter <delay>
14296fastinter <delay>
14297downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014298 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14299 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14300 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14301 between checks depending on the server state :
14302
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014303 Server state | Interval used
14304 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14305 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14306 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14307 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14308 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14309 or yet unchecked. |
14310 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14311 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14312 | "inter" otherwise.
14313 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014315 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14316 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14317 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14318 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014319 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14320 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14321 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14322 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14323 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014324
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014325log-proto <logproto>
14326 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14327 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14328 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14329 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14330
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014331maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014332 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14333 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014334 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14335 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014336 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14337 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14338 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14339 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14340
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014341 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14342 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14343 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14344 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14345 than 50 concurrent requests.
14346
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014347maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014348 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14349 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14350 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14351 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014352 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14353 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14354 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14355 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14356 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14357 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14358 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014359
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014360max-reuse <count>
14361 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14362 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14363 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14364 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14365 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14366 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14367 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14368 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14369
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014370minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014371 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14372 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14373 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14374 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14375 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14376 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014377 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014378 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014379
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014380namespace <name>
14381 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14382 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14383 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14384 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14385
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014386no-agent-check
14387 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14388 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14389 default value.
14390 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14391 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14392
14393no-backup
14394 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14395 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14396 default value.
14397 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14398 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14399
14400no-check
14401 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14402 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14403 default value.
14404 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14405 "default-server" "check" setting.
14406
14407no-check-ssl
14408 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14409 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14410 default value.
14411 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14412 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14413
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014414no-send-proxy
14415 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14416 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14417 default value.
14418 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14419 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14420
14421no-send-proxy-v2
14422 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14423 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14424 default value.
14425 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14426 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14427
14428no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14429 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14430 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14431 default value.
14432 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14433 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14434
14435no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14436 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14437 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14438 default value.
14439 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14440 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14441
14442no-ssl
14443 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14444 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14445 default value.
14446 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14447 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14448
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014449 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14450 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14451 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14452
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014453no-ssl-reuse
14454 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14455 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14456 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14457 and for paranoid users.
14458
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014459no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014460 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14461 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014462 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014463
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014464 Supported in default-server: No
14465
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014466no-tls-tickets
14467 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14468 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14469 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014470 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14471 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014472 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14473 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14474 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014475 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014476
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014477no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014478 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014479 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14480 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014481 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14482 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014483 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014484
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014485 Supported in default-server: No
14486
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014487no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014488 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014489 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14490 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014491 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14492 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014493 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014494
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014495 Supported in default-server: No
14496
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014497no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014498 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014499 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14500 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014501 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14502 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014503 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014504
14505 Supported in default-server: No
14506
14507no-tlsv13
14508 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14509 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14510 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14511 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14512 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014513 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014514
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014515 Supported in default-server: No
14516
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014517no-verifyhost
14518 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14519 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14520 default value.
14521 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14522 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014523
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014524no-tfo
14525 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14526 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14527 default value.
14528 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14529 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14530
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014531non-stick
14532 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14533 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14534 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14535
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014536npn <protocols>
14537 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14538 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14539 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014540 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014541 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14542 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14543 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14544
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014545observe <mode>
14546 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14547 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14548 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14549 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14550 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14551 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014552 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014553
14554 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14555
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014556on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014557 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14558 Currently, four modes are available:
14559 - fastinter: force fastinter
14560 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14561 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14562 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14563 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14564
14565 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14566
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014567on-marked-down <action>
14568 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14569 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014570 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14571 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14572 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14573 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14574 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14575 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14576 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14577 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014578
14579 Actions are disabled by default
14580
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014581on-marked-up <action>
14582 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14583 Currently one action is available:
14584 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14585 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14586 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14587 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014588 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14589 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014590 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14591 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14592
14593 Actions are disabled by default
14594
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014595pool-low-conn <max>
14596 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14597 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14598 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14599 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14600 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14601 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14602 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14603 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14604 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14605 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014606 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14607 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14608 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14609 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014610
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014611pool-max-conn <max>
14612 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14613 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14614 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14615 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14616 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14617 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14618
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014619pool-purge-delay <delay>
14620 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014621 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014622 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014623
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014624port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014625 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014626 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14627 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14628 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14629 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14630 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014631
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014632proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014633 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14634 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14635 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014636 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14637 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14638
14639 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14640 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14641 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14642 also reported (flag=HTX).
14643
14644 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14645 a server line :
14646
14647 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14648 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14649 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14650 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14651
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014652 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014653 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14654
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014655redir <prefix>
14656 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14657 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14658 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14659 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14660 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14661 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14662 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14663 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014664 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014665 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014666 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14667 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14668 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14669 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14670
14671 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14672
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014673rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014674 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14675 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14676 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14677
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014678resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14679 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14680 server.
14681
14682 Available options:
14683
14684 * allow-dup-ip
14685 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14686 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14687 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14688 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14689 For such case, simply enable this option.
14690 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14691
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014692 * ignore-weight
14693 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14694 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14695 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14696
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014697 * prevent-dup-ip
14698 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14699 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14700 same fqdn.
14701 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14702
14703 Example:
14704 backend b_myapp
14705 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14706 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14707 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14708
14709 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14710 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14711 it
14712 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14713 different address
14714
14715 Default value: not set
14716
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014717resolve-prefer <family>
14718 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14719 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14720 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14721 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14722
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014723 Default value: ipv6
14724
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014725 Example:
14726
14727 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014728
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014729resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014730 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014731 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014732 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014733 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14734 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014735 configured network, another address is selected.
14736
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014737 Example:
14738
14739 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014740
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014741resolvers <id>
14742 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14743 hostname.
14744
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014745 Example:
14746
14747 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014748
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014749 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014750
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014751send-proxy
14752 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14753 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14754 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14755 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014756 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14757 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14758 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14759 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14760 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14761 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14762 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14763 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14764 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14765 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014766 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14767 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014768
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014769send-proxy-v2
14770 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14771 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14772 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14773 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014774 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14775 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14776 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14777 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014778
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014779proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014780 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14781 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14782
14783 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14784 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14785 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14786 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14787 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14788 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14789 connection is supported).
14790 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14791 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14792 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14793 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14794 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14795 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14796 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014797
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014798send-proxy-v2-ssl
14799 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14800 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14801 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14802 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14803 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14804 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14805 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014806 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14807 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014808
14809send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14810 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14811 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14812 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14813 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14814 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14815 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14816 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14817 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014818 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14819 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014820
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014821slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014822 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14823 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14824 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14825 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14826 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14827 parameters :
14828
14829 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14830 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14831
14832 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14833 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14834 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14835 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14836
14837 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14838 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14839 seen as failed.
14840
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014841sni <expression>
14842 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14843 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14844 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14845 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014846 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14847 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014848 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014849 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14850 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014851
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014852source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014853source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014854source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014855 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14856 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14857 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14858 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14859
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014860 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14861 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14862 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14863 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14864 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14865 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14866 server.
14867
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014868 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14869 specifying the source address without port(s).
14870
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014871ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014872 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14873 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14874 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14875 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14876 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14877 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014878 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14879 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014880
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014881ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14882 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14883 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14884 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14885
14886ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14887 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14888 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14889 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14890
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014891ssl-reuse
14892 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14893 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14894 default value.
14895 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14896 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14897
14898stick
14899 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14900 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14901 default value.
14902 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14903 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014904
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014905socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014906 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014907 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14908 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14909
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014910tcp-ut <delay>
14911 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14912 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14913 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014914 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014915 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14916 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14917 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14918 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14919 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14920 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14921 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14922 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14923 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14924
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014925tfo
14926 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14927 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14928 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14929 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14930 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014931 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014932
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014933track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014934 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14935 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14936 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14937 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014938 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14939
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014940tls-tickets
14941 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14942 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14943 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014944 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14945 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14946 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014947 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014948 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014949
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014950verify [none|required]
14951 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014952 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014953 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14954 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014955 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014956 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14957 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14958 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14959 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14960 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14961 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14962 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14963 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014964
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014965verifyhost <hostname>
14966 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014967 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14968 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14969 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14970 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14971 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14972 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14973 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14974 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014975
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014976weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014977 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14978 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14979 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014980 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14981 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14982 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14983 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14984 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14985 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014986
14987
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200149885.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14989-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014990
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014991HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14992using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070014993configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014994This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14995can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14996workload.
14997This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14998resolution at run time.
14999Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15000carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15001
15002
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200150035.3.1. Global overview
15004----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015005
15006As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15007different steps of the process life:
15008
15009 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15010 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15011 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15012
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015013 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15014 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015015
15016A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15017 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15018 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15019 resolution to know this new IP.
15020
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015021When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015022HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015023SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15024from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
15025will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
15026will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015027
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015028A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015029 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015030 first valid response.
15031
15032 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15033 servers return an error.
15034
15035
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200150365.3.2. The resolvers section
15037----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015038
15039This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015040HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15041contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015042
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015043When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15044uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15045is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15046answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15047
15048When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015049used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015050
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015051 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15052 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15053 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015054
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015055 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15056 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015057
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015058 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
15059 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15060 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015061
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015062For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15063following scenarios are possible:
15064
15065 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15066 ignored
15067
15068 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15069 applied
15070
15071 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15072 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15073
15074 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15075 retries the query with a new type
15076
15077 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15078 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015079
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015080As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
15081a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015082<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015083
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015084
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015085resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015086 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015087
15088A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15089
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015090accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015091 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015092 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015093 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15094 by RFC 6891)
15095
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015096 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15097 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15098 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15099 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15100 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15101 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015102
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015103nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15104 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15105 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15106 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15107 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15108 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15109 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15110 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15111 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15112 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015113 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15114
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015115parse-resolv-conf
15116 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15117 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15118 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15119
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015120hold <status> <period>
15121 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15122 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015123 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015124 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015125 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15126 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15127 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15128
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015129 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015130
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015131resolve_retries <nb>
15132 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15133 giving up.
15134 Default value: 3
15135
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015136 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15137 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15138 type.
15139
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015140timeout <event> <time>
15141 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15142 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15143 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015144 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15145 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015146 Default value: 1s
15147 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015148 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015149 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015150 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15151 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15152
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015153 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015154
15155 resolvers mydns
15156 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15157 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015158 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015159 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015160 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015161 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015162 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015163 hold other 30s
15164 hold refused 30s
15165 hold nx 30s
15166 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015167 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015168 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015169
15170
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200151716. Cache
15172---------
15173
15174HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15175(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15176RAM.
15177
15178The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15179this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15180
15181If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15182independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15183when we try to allocate a new one.
15184
15185The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15186
15187It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15188"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15189for more details.
15190
15191When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15192replaced by "<CACHE>".
15193
15194
151956.1. Limitation
15196----------------
15197
15198The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15199
15200- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015201- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15202 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15203 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015204- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15205- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015206- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15207 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15208 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015209- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15210 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015211- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15212 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15213 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015214
15215- If the request is not a GET
15216- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15217- If the request contains an Authorization header
15218
15219
152206.2. Setup
15221-----------
15222
15223To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15224the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15225
15226
152276.2.1. Cache section
15228---------------------
15229
15230cache <name>
15231 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15232 size of cache is mandatory.
15233
15234total-max-size <megabytes>
15235 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15236 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15237
15238max-object-size <bytes>
15239 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15240 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15241 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15242
15243max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015244 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015245 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15246 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15247 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15248 default.
15249
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015250process-vary <on/off>
15251 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015252 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15253 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15254 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015255 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015256
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015257max-secondary-entries <number>
15258 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15259 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15260 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15261
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015262
152636.2.2. Proxy section
15264---------------------
15265
15266http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15267 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15268 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15269 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15270 after this one.
15271
15272http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15273 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15274 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15275 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15276 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15277
15278
15279Example:
15280
15281 backend bck1
15282 mode http
15283
15284 http-request cache-use foobar
15285 http-response cache-store foobar
15286 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15287
15288 cache foobar
15289 total-max-size 4
15290 max-age 240
15291
15292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200152937. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15294----------------------------------
15295
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015296HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015297client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15298The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15299these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15300but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15301data called patterns.
15302
15303
153047.1. ACL basics
15305---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015306
15307The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15308content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15309from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15310simple :
15311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015312 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015313 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015314 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15315 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015317The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15318adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015319
15320In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015322 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015323
15324This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15325Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15326and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015327an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15328conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15329as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15330are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015331
15332ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15333'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15334which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15335
15336There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15337performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015339The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15340specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15341this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015342methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15343ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015344
15345Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15346 - boolean
15347 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15348 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15349 - string
15350 - data block
15351
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015352Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15353converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15354would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15355The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15356which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15357
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015358Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15359keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15360fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15361which are summarized in the table below :
15362
15363 +---------------------+-----------------+
15364 | Sample or converter | Default |
15365 | output type | matching method |
15366 +---------------------+-----------------+
15367 | boolean | bool |
15368 +---------------------+-----------------+
15369 | integer | int |
15370 +---------------------+-----------------+
15371 | ip | ip |
15372 +---------------------+-----------------+
15373 | string | str |
15374 +---------------------+-----------------+
15375 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15376 +---------------------+-----------------+
15377
15378Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15379matching method, see below.
15380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015381The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15382 - boolean
15383 - integer or integer range
15384 - IP address / network
15385 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15386 - regular expression
15387 - hex block
15388
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015389The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15390
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015391 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15392 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015393 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015394 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015395 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015396 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015397 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015399The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15400read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15401if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15402lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15403will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15404beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
15405a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
15406lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15407exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15408
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015409The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15410parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15411ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15412a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15413check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15414
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015415The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15416socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15417file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015419Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15420loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15421
15422 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15423
15424In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15425the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15426case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15427as well.
15428
15429The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15430sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15431do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15432methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15433is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015434obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015435followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15436default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15437that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15438string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15439
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015440The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15441By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15442string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15443resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
15444server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015445waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015446flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15447function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015449There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15450sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15451be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015452
15453 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15454 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015455 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15456 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15457 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15458 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015459
15460 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15461 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015462 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015463
15464 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015465 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015466
15467 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015468 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015469
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015470 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015471 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15472
15473 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15474 binary or string samples.
15475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015476 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15477 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015479 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15480 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15481 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015483 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15484 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015486 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15487 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015489 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15490 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015492 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15493 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015494 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015496 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15497 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15498 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015499
15500For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15501request, it is possible to do :
15502
15503 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15504
15505In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15506buffer, one would use the following acl :
15507
15508 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15509
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015510On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15511possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15512
15513 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015515All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15516criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15517method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15518to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15519criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15520the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015522If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015523the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15524For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015526 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15527 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15528 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15529 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015530
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015531
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015532The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15533types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15534combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15535brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15536default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015538 +-------------------------------------------------+
15539 | Input sample type |
15540 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015541 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015542 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15543 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15544 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015545 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015546 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015547 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015548 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015549 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015550 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015551 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015552 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015553 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015554 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015555 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015556 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015557 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015558 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015559 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015560 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015561 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015562 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015563 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015564 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015565 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015566 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15567 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15568 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015569
15570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155717.1.1. Matching booleans
15572------------------------
15573
15574In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15575Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15576When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15577that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15578
15579Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15580return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15581"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15582
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155847.1.2. Matching integers
15585------------------------
15586
15587Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15588enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15589to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15590
15591Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15592matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15593lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015594
15595For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15596unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15597representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15598
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015599As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15600two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15601instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15602ranges and operators.
15603
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015604For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015605operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15606Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15607of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015608
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015609Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015610
15611 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15612 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15613 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15614 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15615 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15616
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015617For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015618
15619 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15620
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015621This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15622
15623 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15624
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156267.1.3. Matching strings
15627-----------------------
15628
15629String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15630different forms :
15631
15632 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015633 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015634
15635 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015636 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015637
15638 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15639 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15640
15641 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15642 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15643
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015644 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015645 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15646 matches.
15647
15648 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15649 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15650 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015651
15652String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15653exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15654characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15655string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15656to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015657before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015658
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015659Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15660(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15661Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15662
15663Example:
15664 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15665 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15666
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156687.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15669---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015670
15671Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15672they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15673possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15674passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15675the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015676the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15677match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015678
15679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15681-------------------------------------
15682
15683It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15684not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15685a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15686to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15687digits may be used upper or lower case.
15688
15689Example :
15690 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15691 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15692
15693
156947.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15695---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015696
15697IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15698netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15699within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015700host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015701difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15702at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15703does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15704parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015705
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015706The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15707abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15708
15709 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15710 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15711 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15712 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15713 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15714 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15715 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15716 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15717
15718Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15719192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15720
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015721IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15722Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15723trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15724IPv6 patterns.
15725
15726HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15727following situations :
15728 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15729 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15730 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15731 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15732 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15733 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15734 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15735 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15736 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15737 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015739
157407.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15741----------------------------------
15742
15743Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15744combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15745
15746 - AND (implicit)
15747 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15748 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015750A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015752 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015754Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15755indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015757For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15758"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15759requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15760is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15761
15762 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015763 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15764 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15765 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015766
15767To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15768and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15769
15770 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15771 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15772 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15773 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15774
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015775 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015776 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15777 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15778 use_backend www if host_www
15779
15780It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15781expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15782be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15783the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15784
15785 The following rule :
15786
15787 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015788 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015789
15790 Can also be written that way :
15791
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015792 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015793
15794It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15795to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15796simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15797sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15798good use is the following :
15799
15800 With named ACLs :
15801
15802 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15803 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15804 monitor fail if site_dead
15805
15806 With anonymous ACLs :
15807
15808 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15809
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015810See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15811keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015812
15813
158147.3. Fetching samples
15815---------------------
15816
15817Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15818against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15819sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15820ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15821of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15822available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15823
15824This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15825Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15826compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15827deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15828
15829The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15830matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15831method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15832indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15833
15834As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15835when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15836mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15837the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15838ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15839
15840Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15841multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15842when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015843incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15844are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015845is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15846all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15847
15848Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15849 - name
15850 - name(arg1)
15851 - name(arg1,arg2)
15852
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015853
158547.3.1. Converters
15855-----------------
15856
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015857Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15858of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15859is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15860was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015861has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015862unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15863
15864These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15865sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15866the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015867support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015868
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015869A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15870support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15871supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15872(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15873bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015875The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015876
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001587751d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15878 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15879 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15880 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15881 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15882 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15883
15884 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015885 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15886 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015887 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15888 frontend http-in
15889 bind *:8081
15890 default_backend servers
15891 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15892 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15893
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015894add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015895 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015896 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015897 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15898 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015899 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015900 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15901 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15902 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15903 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015904 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015905 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015906
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015907aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15908 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15909 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15910 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15911 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15912 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15913 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15914
15915 Example:
15916 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15917 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15918
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015919and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015920 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015921 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015922 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15923 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015924 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015925 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15926 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15927 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15928 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015929 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015930 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015931
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015932b64dec
15933 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15934 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015935 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
15936 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015937
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015938base64
15939 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015940 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015941 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
15942 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015943
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015944bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015945 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015946 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015947 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015948 presence of a flag).
15949
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015950bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15951 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15952 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015953 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015954
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015955concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15956 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15957 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15958 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15959 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15960 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15961 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15962 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15963 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15964 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15965 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015966 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015967 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015968 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15969 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015970
15971 Example:
15972 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15973 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15974 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015975 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015976 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15977
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015978cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015979 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15980 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015981
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015982crc32([<avalanche>])
15983 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15984 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15985 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15986 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15987 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15988 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15989 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15990 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15991 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15992 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015993 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15994
15995crc32c([<avalanche>])
15996 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15997 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15998 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15999 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16000 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16001 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16002 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16003 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016004
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016005cut_crlf
16006 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16007 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16008 updated.
16009
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016010da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016011 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16012 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16013 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16014 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016015 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016016 configuration language.
16017
16018 Example:
16019 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016020 bind *:8881
16021 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016022 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016023
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016024debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16025 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16026 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16027 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16028 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16029 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16030 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16031 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16032 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16033 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16034 printable sample types.
16035
16036 Example:
16037 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016038
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016039digest(<algorithm>)
16040 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16041 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16042
16043 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16044 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16045
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016046div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016047 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16048 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016049 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016050 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16051 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016052 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016053 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16054 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16055 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16056 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016057 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016058 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016059
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016060djb2([<avalanche>])
16061 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16062 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16063 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16064 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16065 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16066 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16067 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016068 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16069 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016070
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016071even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016072 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016073 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16074
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016075field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16076 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16077 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16078 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16079 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16080 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16081 fields.
16082
16083 Example :
16084 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16085 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16086 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16087 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16088 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016089
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016090fix_is_valid
16091 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16092 Information eXchange):
16093
16094 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16095 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016096 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016097 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016098 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016099 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16100 checksum
16101
16102 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16103 the server can be parsed.
16104
16105 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16106 message, false if not.
16107
16108 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16109
16110 Example:
16111 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16112 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16113
16114fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16115 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16116 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16117 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16118 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016119 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016120 added.
16121
16122 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16123 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16124 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16125 fix_is_valid converter.
16126
16127 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16128
16129 Example:
16130 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16131 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16132 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16133 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16134 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16135
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016136hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016137 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016138 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016139 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016140 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016141
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016142hex2i
16143 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016144 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016145
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016146htonl
16147 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16148 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16149 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16150 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16151
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016152hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016153 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16154 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16155 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16156 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16157
16158 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16159 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16160
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016161http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016162 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16163 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016164 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16165 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16166 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16167 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16168 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16169 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16170 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16171 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016172
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016173iif(<true>,<false>)
16174 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16175 string otherwise.
16176
16177 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016178 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016179
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016180in_table(<table>)
16181 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16182 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16183 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016184 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016185 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16186
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016187ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016188 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016189 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016190 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16191 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16192 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16193 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16194 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016195
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016196json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016197 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016198 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016199 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016200 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16201 of errors:
16202 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16203 bytes, ...)
16204 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16205 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16206
16207 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16208 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16209 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16210 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16211 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16212 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016213 - "ascii" : never fails;
16214 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16215 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016216 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016217 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016218 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16219 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16220
16221 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016222 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016223
16224 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016225 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016226 capture request header user-agent len 150
16227 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016228
16229 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16230 GET / HTTP/1.0
16231 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16232
16233 Output log:
16234 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16235
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016236json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16237 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16238 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16239 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16240 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16241
16242 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16243 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16244
16245 Example:
16246 # get a integer value from the request body
16247 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16248 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16249
16250 # get a key with '.' in the name
16251 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16252 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16253
16254 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16255 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16256
16257 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16258 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16259
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016260language(<value>[,<default>])
16261 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16262 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16263 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16264 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16265 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16266 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16267 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16268 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16269 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016270 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016271 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16272 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016273
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016274 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016275
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016276 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16277 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016278
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016279 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16280 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16281 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16282 use_backend spanish if es
16283 use_backend french if fr
16284 use_backend english if en
16285 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016286
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016287length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016288 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16289 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16290 type. The result is of type integer.
16291
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016292lower
16293 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16294 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16295 type. The result is of type string.
16296
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016297ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16298 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16299 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16300 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16301 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16302 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16303 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16304
16305 Example :
16306
16307 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016308 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016309 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16310
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016311ltrim(<chars>)
16312 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16313 representation of the input sample.
16314
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016315map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16316map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16317map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16318 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16319 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16320 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16321 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16322 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16323 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16324 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16325 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016326
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016327 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16328 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16329 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016330
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016331 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016332 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016333
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016334 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16335 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16336 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16337 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016338 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16339 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016340 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16341 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16342 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16343 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16344 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16345 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16346 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16347 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016348 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16349 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16350 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016351 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16352 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16353 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16354 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16355 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016356
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016357 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16358 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16359 the corresponding match text.
16360
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016361 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16362 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16363 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16364 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16365 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016366
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016367 Example :
16368
16369 # this is a comment and is ignored
16370 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16371 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16372 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16373 | | | `---------- value
16374 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16375 | `---------------------------- key
16376 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16377
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016378mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016379 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16380 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016381 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016382 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016383 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016384 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16385 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16386 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16387 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016388 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016389 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016390
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016391mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016392 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16393 <packettype>.
16394 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16395 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16396 from.
16397 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16398 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16399 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16400
16401 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16402 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16403 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16404 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16405
16406 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16407 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16408 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16409 packets only):
16410 17: Session Expiry Interval
16411 33: Receive Maximum
16412 39: Maximum Packet Size
16413 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16414 25: Request Response Information
16415 23: Request Problem Information
16416 21: Authentication Method
16417 22: Authentication Data
16418 18: Will Delay Interval
16419 1: Payload Format Indicator
16420 2: Message Expiry Interval
16421 3: Content Type
16422 8: Response Topic
16423 9: Correlation Data
16424 Not supported yet:
16425 38: User Property
16426
16427 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16428 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16429 packets only):
16430 17: Session Expiry Interval
16431 33: Receive Maximum
16432 36: Maximum QoS
16433 37: Retain Available
16434 39: Maximum Packet Size
16435 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16436 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16437 31: Reason String
16438 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16439 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16440 42: Shared Subscription Available
16441 19: Server Keep Alive
16442 26: Response Information
16443 28: Server Reference
16444 21: Authentication Method
16445 22: Authentication Data
16446 Not supported yet:
16447 38: User Property
16448
16449 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16450 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16451 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16452 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16453
16454 Example:
16455
16456 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16457 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16458 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16459 if data_in_buffer
16460 # do the same as above
16461 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16462 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16463 if data_in_buffer
16464
16465mqtt_is_valid
16466 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16467
16468 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16469 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16470 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16471 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16472
16473 Example:
16474
16475 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16476 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
16477
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016478mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016479 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016480 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16481 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016482 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016483 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016484 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016485 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16486 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16487 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16488 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016489 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016490 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016491
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016492nbsrv
16493 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16494 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16495 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16496 map lookup.
16497
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016498neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016499 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16500 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16501 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16502 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016503
16504not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016505 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016506 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016507 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016508 absence of a flag).
16509
16510odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016511 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016512 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16513
16514or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016515 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016516 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016517 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16518 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016519 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016520 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16521 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16522 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16523 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016524 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016525 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016526
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016527protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16528 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16529 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16530 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16531 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16532 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16533 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16534 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16535 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16536 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16537 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16538 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16539
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016540regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016541 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16542 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16543 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16544 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16545 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16546 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16547 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16548 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16549 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016550 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16551 of characters with other ones.
16552
16553 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16554 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16555 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16556 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16557 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16558 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016559
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016560 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016561
16562 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16563 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16564 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016565 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016566
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016567 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16568 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16569
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016570 # capture groups and backreferences
16571 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016572 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016573 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16574
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016575capture-req(<id>)
16576 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16577 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16578
16579 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016580 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16581 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016582
16583capture-res(<id>)
16584 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16585 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16586
16587 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016588 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16589 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016590
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016591rtrim(<chars>)
16592 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16593 of the input sample.
16594
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016595sdbm([<avalanche>])
16596 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16597 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16598 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16599 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16600 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16601 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16602 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016603 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16604 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016605
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016606secure_memcmp(<var>)
16607 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16608 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16609 match.
16610
16611 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16612 performed in constant time.
16613
16614 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16615 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16616
16617 Example :
16618
16619 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16620 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16621 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16622 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16623
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016624set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016625 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16626 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16627 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016628 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016629 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16630 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016631 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016632 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16633 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016634 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016635 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016636
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016637sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016638 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016639 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16640
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016641sha2([<bits>])
16642 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16643 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16644
16645 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16646 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16647
16648 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16649 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16650
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016651srv_queue
16652 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16653 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16654 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16655 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16656 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16657
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016658strcmp(<var>)
16659 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16660 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16661 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16662 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16663 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16664 shorter).
16665
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016666 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16667 strings in constant time.
16668
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016669 Example :
16670
16671 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16672 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16673 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16674
16675
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016676sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016677 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16678 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016679 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016680 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16681 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016682 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016683 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16684 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016685 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016686 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16687 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016688 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016689 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016690
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016691table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16692 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16693 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16694 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16695 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16696 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16697 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16698
16699
16700table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16701 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16702 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16703 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16704 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16705 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16706 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16707
16708table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16709 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16710 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016711 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016712 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16713 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16714
16715table_conn_cur(<table>)
16716 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16717 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16718 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16719 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16720 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16721
16722table_conn_rate(<table>)
16723 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16724 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16725 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16726 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16727 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16728
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016729table_gpt0(<table>)
16730 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16731 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16732 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16733 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16734 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16735
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016736table_gpc0(<table>)
16737 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16738 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16739 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16740 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16741 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16742
16743table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16744 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16745 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16746 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16747 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16748 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16749 sample fetch keyword.
16750
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016751table_gpc1(<table>)
16752 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16753 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16754 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16755 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16756 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16757
16758table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16759 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16760 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16761 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16762 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16763 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16764 sample fetch keyword.
16765
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016766table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16767 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16768 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016769 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016770 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16771 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16772
16773table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16774 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16775 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16776 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16777 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16778 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16779 keyword.
16780
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016781table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16782 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16783 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16784 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16785 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16786 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16787
16788table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16789 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16790 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16791 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16792 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16793 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16794 keyword.
16795
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016796table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16797 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16798 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016799 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016800 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16801 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16802
16803table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16804 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16805 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16806 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16807 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16808 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16809 keyword.
16810
16811table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16812 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16813 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016814 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016815 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16816 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16817 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16818 keyword.
16819
16820table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16821 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16822 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016823 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016824 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16825 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16826 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16827 keyword.
16828
16829table_server_id(<table>)
16830 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16831 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16832 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16833 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16834 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16835 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16836
16837table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16838 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16839 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016840 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016841 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16842 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16843 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16844 keyword.
16845
16846table_sess_rate(<table>)
16847 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16848 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16849 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16850 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16851 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16852 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16853 keyword.
16854
16855table_trackers(<table>)
16856 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16857 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16858 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16859 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16860 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16861 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16862 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16863 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16864 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16865 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16866
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016867ub64dec
16868 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
16869 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
16870 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
16871
16872 Example:
16873 # Decoding a JWT payload:
16874 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
16875
16876ub64enc
16877 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
16878
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016879upper
16880 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16881 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16882 type. The result is of type string.
16883
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016884url_dec([<in_form>])
16885 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16886 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16887 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16888 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16889 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16890 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016891
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016892url_enc([<enc_type>])
16893 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16894 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16895 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16896 optional argument is here for future changes.
16897
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016898ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016899 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016900 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16901 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16902 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016903 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16904 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16905 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16906 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016907 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016908 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16909 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016910
16911 Example:
16912 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16913 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16914
16915 message Point {
16916 int32 latitude = 1;
16917 int32 longitude = 2;
16918 }
16919
16920 message PPoint {
16921 Point point = 59;
16922 }
16923
16924 message Rectangle {
16925 // One corner of the rectangle.
16926 PPoint lo = 48;
16927 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16928 PPoint hi = 49;
16929 }
16930
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016931 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16932 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16933 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016934
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016935 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16936 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016937 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016938 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16939
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016940 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016941
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016942 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016943
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016944 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16945 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16946 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016947
16948 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16949 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16950 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16951
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016952 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16953 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16954 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016955
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016956
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016957unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016958 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16959 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16960 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16961 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16962 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16963 response),
16964 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16965 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16966 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16967 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16968
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016969utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16970 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16971 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16972 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16973 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16974 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16975 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16976
16977 Example :
16978
16979 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016980 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016981 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16982
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016983word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16984 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16985 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16986 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016987 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016988 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16989 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16990
16991 Example :
16992 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16993 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16994 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16995 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16996 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016997 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016998
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016999wt6([<avalanche>])
17000 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17001 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17002 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17003 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17004 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17005 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17006 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017007 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17008 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017009
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017010xor(<value>)
17011 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017012 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017013 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017014 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017015 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017016 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17017 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017018 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017019 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17020 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017021 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017022 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017023
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017024xxh3([<seed>])
17025 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17026 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17027 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17028 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17029 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17030 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17031 considered as cryptographically secure.
17032
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017033xxh32([<seed>])
17034 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17035 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17036 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17037 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17038 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17039 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17040 as cryptographically secure.
17041
17042xxh64([<seed>])
17043 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17044 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17045 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17046 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17047 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17048 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17049 as cryptographically secure.
17050
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017051
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200170527.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017053--------------------------------------------
17054
17055A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17056not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17057"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17058The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17059
17060always_false : boolean
17061 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17062 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17063
17064always_true : boolean
17065 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17066 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17067
17068avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017069 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017070 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17071 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17072 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17073 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17074 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17075 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17076 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17077 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17078 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17079 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17080 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17081 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17082 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017084be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017085 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17086 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17087 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17088 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017089 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17090
17091be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17092 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17093 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17094 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17095 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17096 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017097 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17098 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017099
17100 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17101 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17102 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017104be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17105 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17106 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17107 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017108 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017109 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17110 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017111
17112 Example :
17113 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17114 backend dynamic
17115 mode http
17116 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17117 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017118
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017119bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017120 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17121 of the string.
17122
17123bool(<bool>) : bool
17124 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17125 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017127connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17128 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017129 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017130 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17131 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017132
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017133 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017134 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017135 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17136
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017137 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17138 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017139
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017140 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017141 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017142 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017143 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017144 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017145 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017146 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017147
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017148 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17149 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017150 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017151 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017152
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017153cpu_calls : integer
17154 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17155 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17156 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17157 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17158 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17159 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17160
17161cpu_ns_avg : integer
17162 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17163 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17164 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17165 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17166 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17167 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17168 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17169 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17170 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17171 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17172 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17173
17174cpu_ns_tot : integer
17175 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17176 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17177 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17178 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17179 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17180 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17181 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17182 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17183 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17184 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17185 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17186 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17187 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17188
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017189date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017190 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017191
17192 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17193 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17194 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017195 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17196
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017197 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17198 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17199 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17200 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17201 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17202
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017203 Example :
17204
17205 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17206 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017207
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017208 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17209 # millisecond granularity
17210 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17211
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017212date_us : integer
17213 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17214 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17215 from the same timeval structure.
17216
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017217distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17218 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17219 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17220 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17221 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
17222 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
17223 list of supported tokens.
17224
17225distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17226 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17227 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17228 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17229 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
17230 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
17231 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17232 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17233 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17234 supported tokens.
17235
17236 Example :
17237 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17238 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17239 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17240 # send large files to the big farm
17241 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17242
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017243env(<name>) : string
17244 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17245 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17246 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17247 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17248 certain way.
17249
17250 Examples :
17251 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17252 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17253
17254 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17255 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017257fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17258 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017259 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17260 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017261 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17262 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017263 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017264 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17265 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017266
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017267fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17268 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17269 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17270 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017272fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17273 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17274 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17275 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17276 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17277 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17278 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17279 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17280 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017281
17282 Example :
17283 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17284 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17285 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17286 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17287 frontend mail
17288 bind :25
17289 mode tcp
17290 maxconn 100
17291 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17292 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17293 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17294 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017295
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017296hostname : string
17297 Returns the system hostname.
17298
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017299int(<integer>) : signed integer
17300 Returns a signed integer.
17301
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017302ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17303 Returns an ipv4.
17304
17305ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17306 Returns an ipv6.
17307
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017308lat_ns_avg : integer
17309 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17310 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17311 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17312 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17313 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17314 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17315 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17316 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17317 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017318 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17319 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17320 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17321 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17322 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17323 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017324
17325lat_ns_tot : integer
17326 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17327 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17328 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17329 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17330 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17331 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17332 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17333 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17334 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017335 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17336 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17337 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17338 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17339 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017340 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17341 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17342 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17343 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17344 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17345 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17346
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017347meth(<method>) : method
17348 Returns a method.
17349
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017350nbproc : integer
17351 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17352 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17353 and debugging purposes.
17354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017355nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17356 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17357 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17358 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017359 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17360 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17361 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017362
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017363prio_class : integer
17364 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17365 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17366 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17367
17368prio_offset : integer
17369 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17370 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17371 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17372 set-priority-offset".
17373
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017374proc : integer
17375 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17376 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17377 debugging purposes.
17378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017379queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017380 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17381 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17382 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017383 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17384 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17385 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17386 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17387 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17388
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017389rand([<range>]) : integer
17390 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17391 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17392 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17393 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17394 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17395
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020017396uuid([<version>]) : string
17397 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17398 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17399 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017401srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17402 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17403 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17404 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17405 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17406 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017407 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17408 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17409
17410srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17411 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17412 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17413 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17414 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17415 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17416 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17417 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17418
17419 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17420 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017421
17422srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17423 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17424 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17425 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017426 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017427 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17428 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17429 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17430
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017431srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17432 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17433 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17434 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17435 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17436 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17437 fetch methods.
17438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017439srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17440 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17441 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017442 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017443 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17444 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017445 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017446 overloading servers).
17447
17448 Example :
17449 # Redirect to a separate back
17450 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17451 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17452 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17453
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017454srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017455 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17456 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17457 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17458
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017459srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017460 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17461 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17462 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17463
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017464srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017465 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17466 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17467 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17468
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017469stopping : boolean
17470 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17471 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17472 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17473
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017474str(<string>) : string
17475 Returns a string.
17476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017477table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17478 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17479 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17480
17481table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17482 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17483 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17484 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17485
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017486thread : integer
17487 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17488 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17489 and debugging purposes.
17490
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017491var(<var-name>) : undefined
17492 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017493 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17494 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017495 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017496 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17497 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017498 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017499 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17500 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017501 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017502 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017503
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200175047.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017505----------------------------------
17506
17507The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
17508closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17509methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17510sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17511TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017512the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17513counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017514"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17515used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17516can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17517Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17518table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17519tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17520currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017521
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017522bc_dst : ip
17523 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17524 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17525 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17526 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17527
17528bc_dst_port : integer
17529 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17530 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected to.
17531
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017532bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017533 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17534 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17535 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17536
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017537bc_src : ip
17538 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
17539 the server address haproxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
17540 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17541 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17542
17543bc_src_port : integer
17544 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17545 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected from.
17546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017547be_id : integer
17548 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017549 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17550 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017551
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017552be_name : string
17553 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017554 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17555 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017556
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017557be_server_timeout : integer
17558 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17559 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17560 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17561
17562be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17563 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17564 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17565 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17566
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017567cur_server_timeout : integer
17568 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17569 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17570 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17571
17572cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17573 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17574 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17575 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017577dst : ip
17578 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17579 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17580 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17581 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017582 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17583 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17584 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17585 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17586 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17587 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017588
17589dst_conn : integer
17590 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17591 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17592 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17593 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17594 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17595 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17596 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17597 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017598
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017599dst_is_local : boolean
17600 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17601 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17602 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17603 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017604 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017605 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17606 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17607 it only once per connection.
17608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017609dst_port : integer
17610 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17611 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17612 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17613 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17614 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17615 an HTTP header.
17616
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017617fc_http_major : integer
17618 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17619 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17620 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17621
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017622fc_pp_authority : string
17623 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17624 if any.
17625
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017626fc_pp_unique_id : string
17627 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17628 if any.
17629
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017630fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17631 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17632 header.
17633
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017634fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17635 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17636 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17637 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17638 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17639 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17640 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17641
17642fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17643 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17644 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17645 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17646 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17647 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17648 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17649
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017650fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017651 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17652 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17653 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17654 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17655
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017656fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017657 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17658 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17659 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17660 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17661
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017662fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017663 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17664 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17665 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17666 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17667
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017668fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017669 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17670 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17671 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17672 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17673
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017674fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017675 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17676 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17677 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17678 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17679
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017680fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017681 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17682 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17683 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17684 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17685
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017686fe_defbe : string
17687 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17688 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017690fe_id : integer
17691 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017692 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017693 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17694
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017695fe_name : string
17696 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17697 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17698 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17699
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017700fe_client_timeout : integer
17701 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17702 current frontend.
17703
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017704sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017705sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17706sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17707sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017708 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17709 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17710 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17711
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017712sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017713sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17714sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17715sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017716 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17717 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17718 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17719
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017720sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017721sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17722sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17723sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017724 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17725 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017726 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17727 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17728 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017729
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017730 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017731 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17732 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017733 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17734 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17735 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017736 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17737 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17738
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017739sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17740sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17741sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17742sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17743 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17744 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17745 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17746 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17747 when a first ACL was verified.
17748
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017749sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017750sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17751sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17752sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017753 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017754 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17755
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017756sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017757sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17758sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17759sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017760 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17761 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17762 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17763
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017764sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017765sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17766sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17767sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017768 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17769 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17770 See also src_conn_rate.
17771
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017772sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017773sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17774sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17775sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017776 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017777 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017778
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017779sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17780sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17781sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17782sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17783 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17784 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17785
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017786sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17787sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17788sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17789sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17790 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17791 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17792
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017793sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017794sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17795sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17796sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017797 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17798 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17799 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017800 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17801 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17802 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017803
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017804sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17805sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17806sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17807sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17808 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17809 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17810 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17811 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17812 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17813 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17814
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017815sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017816sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17817sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17818sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017819 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017820 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17821 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17822
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017823sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017824sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17825sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17826sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017827 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17828 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17829 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17830 src_http_err_rate.
17831
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017832sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17833sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17834sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17835sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17836 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17837 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17838 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17839
17840sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17841sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17842sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17843sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17844 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
17845 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
17846 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
17847 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
17848
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017849sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017850sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17851sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17852sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017853 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017854 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17855 src_http_req_cnt.
17856
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017857sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017858sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17859sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17860sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017861 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17862 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17863 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17864 src_http_req_rate.
17865
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017866sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017867sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17868sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17869sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017870 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017871 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17872 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17873 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17874 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017875
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017876 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017877 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17878 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017879 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17880
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017881sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17882sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17883sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17884sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17885 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17886 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17887 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17888 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17889 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17890
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017891sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017892sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17893sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17894sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017895 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17896 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17897 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017898
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017899sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017900sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17901sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17902sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017903 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17904 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17905 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017906
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017907sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017908sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17909sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17910sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017911 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017912 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17913 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17914 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017915 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017916 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17917
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017918sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017919sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17920sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17921sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017922 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17923 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17924 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17925 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17926 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017927 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017928
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017929sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017930sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17931sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17932sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017933 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17934 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17935 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17936
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017937sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017938sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17939sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17940sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017941 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17942 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017943 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017944 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17945 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017946 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17947 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17948 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017950so_id : integer
17951 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17952 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17953 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017954
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017955so_name : string
17956 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17957 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17958 strings instead of integers.
17959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017960src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017961 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017962 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17963 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17964 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017965 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17966 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17967 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017968 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17969 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17970 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17971 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17972 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17973 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17974 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017975
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017976 Example:
17977 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17978 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017980src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17981 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17982 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17983 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017984 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017986src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17987 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17988 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017989 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017990 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017992src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17993 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17994 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17995 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17996 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17997 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17998 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017999
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018000 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018001 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18002 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18003 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18004 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018005 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018006 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18007 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18008
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018009src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18010 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18011 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18012 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18013 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18014 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18015 was verified.
18016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018017src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018018 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018019 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018020 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018021 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018023src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018024 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018025 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18026 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018027 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018029src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18030 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18031 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18032 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018033 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018035src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018036 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018037 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018038 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018039 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018040
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018041src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18042 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18043 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18044 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18045 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18046
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018047src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18048 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18049 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18050 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18051 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018053src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018054 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018055 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018056 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18057 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018058 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18059 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18060 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018061
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018062src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18063 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18064 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18065 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18066 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18067 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18068 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18069 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018071src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018072 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018073 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018074 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018075 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018076 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018078src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18079 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18080 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18081 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18082 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018083 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018084
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018085src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18086 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18087 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018088 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018089 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18090 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18091
18092src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18093 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18094 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18095 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18096 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18097 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18098 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018100src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018101 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018102 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18103 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018104 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018106src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18107 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18108 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18109 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018110 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018111 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018113src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18114 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18115 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18116 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018117 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018118 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18119 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018120
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018121 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018122 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018123 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018124 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018125
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018126src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18127 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18128 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18129 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18130 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18131 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18132 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18133
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018134src_is_local : boolean
18135 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18136 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18137 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18138 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018139 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018140 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18141 once per connection.
18142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018143src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018144 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18145 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18146 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18147 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18148 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018150src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018151 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18152 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18153 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18154 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18155 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018157src_port : integer
18158 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18159 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18160 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18161 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018163src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018164 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018165 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18166 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18167 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018168 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018170src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18171 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18172 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18173 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18174 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018175 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018177src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18178 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18179 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18180 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18181 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18182 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18183 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18184 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18185 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018186
18187 Example :
18188 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18189 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18190 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18191 listen ssh
18192 bind :22
18193 mode tcp
18194 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018195 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018196 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018197 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018199srv_id : integer
18200 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18201 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018202 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018203
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018204srv_name : string
18205 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18206 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018207 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018208
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200182097.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018210----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018212The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
18213closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18214when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18215usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018216future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018217
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001821851d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18219 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18220 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18221 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18222 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18223 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18224
18225 Example :
18226 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18227 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18228 # the request.
18229 frontend http-in
18230 bind *:8081
18231 default_backend servers
18232 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18233 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18234
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018235ssl_bc : boolean
18236 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18237 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018238 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18239 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018240
18241ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18242 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018243 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18244 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018245
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018246ssl_bc_alpn : string
18247 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18248 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018249 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018250 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18251 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18252 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18253 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18254 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018255 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18256 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018257
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018258ssl_bc_cipher : string
18259 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018260 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18261 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018262
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018263ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18264 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18265 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18266 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018267 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018268
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018269ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18270 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18271 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018272 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18273 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018274
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018275ssl_bc_npn : string
18276 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18277 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018278 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018279 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18280 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18281 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18282 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018283 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18284 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018285
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018286ssl_bc_protocol : string
18287 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018288 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18289 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018290
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018291ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018292 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018293 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018294 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18295 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018296
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018297ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18298 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18299 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18300 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018301 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018302
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018303ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18304 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18305 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018306 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18307 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018308
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018309ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18310 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18311 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18312 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018313 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018314
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018315ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18316 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018317 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18318 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018320ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18321 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18322 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18323 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18324 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18325 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018327ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18328 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18329 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18330 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18331 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018332
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018333ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018334 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18335 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18336 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018337 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018338 does not support resumed sessions.
18339
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018340ssl_c_der : binary
18341 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18342 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18343 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018345ssl_c_err : integer
18346 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18347 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18348 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18349 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18350 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018351
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018352ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018353 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18354 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18355 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18356 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18357 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18358 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18359 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18360 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018361 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18362 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18363 LDAP v3.
18364 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18365 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018367ssl_c_key_alg : string
18368 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18369 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18370 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018372ssl_c_notafter : string
18373 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18374 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18375 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018377ssl_c_notbefore : string
18378 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18379 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18380 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018381
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018382ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018383 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18384 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18385 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18386 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18387 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18388 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18389 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18390 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018391 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18392 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18393 LDAP v3.
18394 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18395 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018397ssl_c_serial : binary
18398 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18399 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18400 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018402ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18403 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18404 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18405 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018406 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18407 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18408
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018409 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018410 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018412ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18413 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18414 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18415 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018417ssl_c_used : boolean
18418 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18419 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018421ssl_c_verify : integer
18422 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18423 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18424 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18425 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018427ssl_c_version : integer
18428 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18429 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018430
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018431ssl_f_der : binary
18432 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18433 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18434 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18435
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018436ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018437 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18438 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18439 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18440 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018441 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018442 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18443 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18444 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018445 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18446 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18447 LDAP v3.
18448 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18449 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018451ssl_f_key_alg : string
18452 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18453 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18454 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018456ssl_f_notafter : string
18457 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18458 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18459 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018461ssl_f_notbefore : string
18462 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18463 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18464 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018465
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018466ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018467 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18468 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18469 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18470 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18471 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18472 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18473 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18474 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018475 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18476 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18477 LDAP v3.
18478 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18479 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018481ssl_f_serial : binary
18482 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18483 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18484 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018485
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018486ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18487 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18488 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18489 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018491ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18492 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18493 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18494 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018496ssl_f_version : integer
18497 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18498 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18499
18500ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018501 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18502 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18503 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018505 Example :
18506 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18507 listen http-https
18508 bind :80
18509 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18510 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18511
18512ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18513 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18514 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18515
18516ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018517 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018518 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
18519 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
18520 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18521 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18522 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18523 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18524 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18525 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018527ssl_fc_cipher : string
18528 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18529 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018530
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018531ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18532 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18533 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018534 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018535
18536ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18537 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18538 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018539 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018540
18541ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18542 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18543 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18544 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018545 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018546 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018547
18548ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18549 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18550 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018551 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018552
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018553ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18554 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18555 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18556 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18557
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018558ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18559 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18560 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18561 transport layer.
18562 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18563 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18564 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18565 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18566
18567ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18568 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18569 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18570 transport layer.
18571 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18572 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18573 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18574 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18575
18576ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18577 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18578 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18579 transport layer.
18580 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18581 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18582 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18583 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18584
18585ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18586 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18587 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18588 transport layer.
18589 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18590 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18591 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18592 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18593
18594ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18595 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18596 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18597 transport layer.
18598 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18599 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18600 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18601 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018603ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018604 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18605 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018606 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18607 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18608 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18609 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018610
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018611ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18612 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18613 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18614 wait until the handshake happened.
18615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018616ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18617 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018618 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18619 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018620 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018621 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018622
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018623ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018624 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018625 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18626 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018628ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018629 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018630 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
18631 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18632 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18633 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18634 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18635 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18636 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018638ssl_fc_protocol : string
18639 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18640 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018641
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018642ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018643 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018644 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18645 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018646
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018647ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18648 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18649 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18650 transport layer.
18651 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18652 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18653 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18654 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18655
18656ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18657 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18658 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18659 transport layer.
18660 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18661 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18662 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18663 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18664
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018665ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18666 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18667 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18668 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018670ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18671 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18672 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18673 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18674 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018675
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018676ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18677 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18678 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18679 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18680 BoringSSL.
18681
18682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018683ssl_fc_sni : string
18684 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18685 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
18686 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
18687 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18688 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18689
18690 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
18691 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
18692 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018693 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018694 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018696 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018697 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18698 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018700ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18701 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18702 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018703
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018704ssl_s_der : binary
18705 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18706 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18707 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18708
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018709ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18710 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18711 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18712 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018713 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018714 does not support resumed sessions.
18715
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018716ssl_s_key_alg : string
18717 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18718 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18719 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18720
18721ssl_s_notafter : string
18722 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18723 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18724 transport layer.
18725
18726ssl_s_notbefore : string
18727 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18728 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18729 transport layer.
18730
18731ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18732 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18733 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18734 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18735 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18736 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18737 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018738 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18739 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018740 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18741 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18742 LDAP v3.
18743 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18744 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18745
18746ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18747 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18748 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18749 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18750 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18751 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18752 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018753 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18754 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018755 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18756 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18757 LDAP v3.
18758 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18759 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18760
18761ssl_s_serial : binary
18762 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18763 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18764 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18765
18766ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18767 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18768 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18769 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18770
18771ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18772 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18773 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18774 layer.
18775
18776ssl_s_version : integer
18777 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18778 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018779
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200187807.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018781------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018783Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18784sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18785only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18786For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18787be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18788can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18789sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18790for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18791content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018792
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018793Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18794 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
18795 HTTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
18796 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18797 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18798 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18799 sample expression). So be careful.
18800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018801payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018802 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018803 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18804 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018806payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18807 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018808 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018809 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018811req.len : integer
18812req_len : integer (deprecated)
18813 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18814 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18815 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18816 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18817 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18818 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18819 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18820 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018822req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18823 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018824 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18825 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18826 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18827 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018829 ACL alternatives :
18830 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018832req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18833 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18834 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18835 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18836 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018838 ACL alternatives :
18839 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018841 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018843req.proto_http : boolean
18844req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18845 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18846 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18847 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18848 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18849 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18850 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18851 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018853 Example:
18854 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18855 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18856 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018857 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018859req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18860rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18861 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18862 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18863 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18864 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18865 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18866 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18867 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018869 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18870 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18871 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18872 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18873 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18874 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018876 ACL derivatives :
18877 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018879 Example :
18880 listen tse-farm
18881 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18882 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18883 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18884 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18885 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18886 persist rdp-cookie
18887 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18888 # This is only useful makes sense if
18889 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18890 stick-table type string size 204800
18891 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18892 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18893 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018895 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18896 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018898req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18899rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18900 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18901 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18902 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18903 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018905 ACL derivatives :
18906 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018907
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018908req.ssl_alpn : string
18909 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18910 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18911 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18912 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18913 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18914 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018915 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018916
18917 Examples :
18918 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18919 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18920 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018921 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018922 default_backend bk_default
18923
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018924req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18925 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18926 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018927 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18928 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18929 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18930 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18931 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018933req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18934req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18935 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18936 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18937 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18938 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18939 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18940 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18941 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018943req.ssl_sni : string
18944req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18945 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18946 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18947 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18948 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18949 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018950 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18951 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18952 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18953 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18954 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18955 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18956 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18957 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18958 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018960 ACL derivatives :
18961 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018963 Examples :
18964 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18965 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18966 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18967 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18968 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018969
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018970req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18971 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18972 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18973 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18974 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18975 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18976 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18977 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18978 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18979 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018981req.ssl_ver : integer
18982req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18983 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18984 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18985 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18986 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18987 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18988 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18989 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018990 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018991 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018993 ACL derivatives :
18994 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018995
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018996res.len : integer
18997 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18998 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18999 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19000 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19001 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
19002 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
19003 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019004 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019006res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19007 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019008 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019009 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019010 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019011 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019013res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19014 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19015 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19016 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019017 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19018 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019020 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019021
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019022res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19023rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19024 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19025 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19026 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19027 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19028 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19029 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19030 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019032wait_end : boolean
19033 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19034 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019035 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019036 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19037 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019038 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019039 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19040 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019042 Examples :
19043 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19044 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19045 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019047 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19048 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19049 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19050 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19051 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19052 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19053 tcp-request content reject
19054
19055
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200190567.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019057--------------------------------------
19058
19059It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19060This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19061data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19062its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19063HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19064content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19065to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19066more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19067response are indexed.
19068
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019069Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19070 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19071 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19072 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19073 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19074 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19075 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019077base : string
19078 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19079 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19080 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19081 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19082 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19083 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19084 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19085 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19086
19087 ACL derivatives :
19088 base : exact string match
19089 base_beg : prefix match
19090 base_dir : subdir match
19091 base_dom : domain match
19092 base_end : suffix match
19093 base_len : length match
19094 base_reg : regex match
19095 base_sub : substring match
19096
19097base32 : integer
19098 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19099 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19100 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019101 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19102 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19103 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019104
19105base32+src : binary
19106 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19107 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19108 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19109 per-URL counters.
19110
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019111baseq : string
19112 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19113 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19114 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19115 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19116
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019117capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19118 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19119 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19120 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19121
19122capture.req.method : string
19123 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19124 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19125 because it's allocated.
19126
19127capture.req.uri : string
19128 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19129 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19130 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19131 allocated.
19132
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019133capture.req.ver : string
19134 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19135 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19136 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19137
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019138capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19139 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19140 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19141 The first entry is an index of 0.
19142 See also: "capture response header"
19143
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019144capture.res.ver : string
19145 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19146 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19147 persistent flag.
19148
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019149req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019150 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19151 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19152 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019153
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019154req.body_param([<name>) : string
19155 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19156 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19157 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19158 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19159 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19160 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19161 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19162 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19163 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19164 given.
19165
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019166req.body_len : integer
19167 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19168 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019169 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19170 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019171
19172req.body_size : integer
19173 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019174 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19175 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019177req.cook([<name>]) : string
19178cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19179 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19180 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19181 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19182 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19183 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19184 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19185 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19186 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19187
19188 ACL derivatives :
19189 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19190 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19191 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19192 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19193 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19194 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19195 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19196 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019198req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19199cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19200 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19201 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019203req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19204cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19205 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19206 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19207 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19208 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019210cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19211 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19212 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19213 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19214 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019215 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019216 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19217 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19218 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19219 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019221hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19222 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19223 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19224 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19225 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019226 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019228req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019229 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19230 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19231 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19232 with headers such as User-Agent.
19233
19234 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19235 found.
19236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019237 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19238 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19239 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019240 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019242req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19243 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19244 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019245 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19246 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019248req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019249 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19250 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19251 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19252 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19253 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19254 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19255 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19256
19257 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19258 found.
19259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019260 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19261 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19262 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019263 with -1 being the last one.
19264
19265 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19266 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019268 ACL derivatives :
19269 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19270 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19271 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19272 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19273 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19274 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19275 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19276 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19277
19278req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19279hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19280 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19281 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019282 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19283 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19284 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19285
19286 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19287 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19288 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19289
19290 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019291
19292req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19293hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19294 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19295 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19296 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019297 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19298 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19299 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19300 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19301 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019302
19303 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19304
19305 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019306
19307req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19308hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19309 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19310 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19311 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019312
19313 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19314
19315 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019316
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019317req.hdrs : string
19318 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19319 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19320 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19321 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19322
19323req.hdrs_bin : binary
19324 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19325 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19326 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19327 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19328 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19329 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19330
19331 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019332
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019333 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19334 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019336http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19337 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19338 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19339 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19340 basic auth is supported.
19341
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019342http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19343 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19344 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19345 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19346 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019347 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19348 basic auth is supported.
19349
19350 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019351 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19352 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19353 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19354 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019355
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019356http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019357 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19358 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19359 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019360
19361http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019362 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19363 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19364 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019365
19366http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019367 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19368 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19369 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019371http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019372 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19373 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019374 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19375 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019377method : integer + string
19378 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19379 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19380 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19381 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19382 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19383 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19384 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019386 ACL derivatives :
19387 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019389 Example :
19390 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19391 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19392 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019394path : string
19395 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19396 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19397 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19398 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19399 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019400 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019401 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019403 ACL derivatives :
19404 path : exact string match
19405 path_beg : prefix match
19406 path_dir : subdir match
19407 path_dom : domain match
19408 path_end : suffix match
19409 path_len : length match
19410 path_reg : regex match
19411 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019412
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019413pathq : string
19414 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19415 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19416 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19417 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19418 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19419 result in both cases.
19420
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019421query : string
19422 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19423 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19424 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19425 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019426 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019427 which stops before the question mark.
19428
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019429req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19430 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19431 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19432 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19433 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019435req.ver : string
19436req_ver : string (deprecated)
19437 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19438 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19439 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019441 ACL derivatives :
19442 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019443
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019444res.body : binary
19445 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19446 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019447 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19448
19449 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019450
19451res.body_len : integer
19452 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19453 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019454 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19455
19456 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019457
19458res.body_size : integer
19459 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19460 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19461 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19462 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019463 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19464
19465 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019466
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019467res.cache_hit : boolean
19468 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19469 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19470
19471res.cache_name : string
19472 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19473 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19474 empty string.
19475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019476res.comp : boolean
19477 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19478 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19479 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019481res.comp_algo : string
19482 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19483 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19484 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019486res.cook([<name>]) : string
19487scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19488 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19489 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019490 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19491
19492 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019494 ACL derivatives :
19495 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019497res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19498scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19499 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19500 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019501 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19502
19503 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019505res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19506scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19507 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19508 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019509 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19510
19511 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019513res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019514 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19515 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19516
19517 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19518 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19519
19520 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19521
19522 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019524res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019525 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19526 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19527
19528 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19529 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19530
19531 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019533res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19534shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019535 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19536 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19537
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019538 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019539 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19540
19541 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019543 ACL derivatives :
19544 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19545 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19546 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19547 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19548 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19549 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19550 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19551 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19552
19553res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19554shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019555 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19556 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19557
19558 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019559 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019560
19561 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019563res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19564shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019565 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19566 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19567
19568 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19569
19570 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019571
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019572res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19573 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19574 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19575 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019576 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19577
19578 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019580res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19581shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019582 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19583 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19584
19585 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19586
19587 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019588
19589res.hdrs : string
19590 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19591 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19592 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019593 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19594
19595 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019596
19597res.hdrs_bin : binary
19598 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19599 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19600 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19601 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19602 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19603 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19604 (length of 0 for both).
19605
19606 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19607
19608 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19609 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019611res.ver : string
19612resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19613 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019614 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19615
19616 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019618 ACL derivatives :
19619 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019621set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19622 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19623 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019624 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019625 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019627 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19628 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019630status : integer
19631 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19632 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019633 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19634
19635 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019636
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019637unique-id : string
19638 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19639 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19640 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19641 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19642 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19643 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019645url : string
19646 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19647 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19648 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19649 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19650 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19651 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19652 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019654 ACL derivatives :
19655 url : exact string match
19656 url_beg : prefix match
19657 url_dir : subdir match
19658 url_dom : domain match
19659 url_end : suffix match
19660 url_len : length match
19661 url_reg : regex match
19662 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019664url_ip : ip
19665 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19666 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19667 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19668 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19669 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19670 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19671 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019673url_port : integer
19674 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19675 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19676 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19677 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019678
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019679urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19680url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019681 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19682 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019683 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19684 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19685 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19686 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019687 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19688 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019689 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19690 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019692 ACL derivatives :
19693 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19694 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19695 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19696 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19697 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19698 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19699 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19700 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019701
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019703 Example :
19704 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19705 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19706 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19707 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019708
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019709urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019710 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19711 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19712 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019713
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019714url32 : integer
19715 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19716 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19717 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19718 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19719 is an unsigned integer.
19720
19721url32+src : binary
19722 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19723 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19724 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19725
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019726
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200197277.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019728---------------------------------------
19729
19730This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19731used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19732purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19733There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19734or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19735any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19736for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19737
19738internal.htx.data : integer
19739 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19740 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19741
19742internal.htx.free : integer
19743 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19744 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19745
19746internal.htx.free_data : integer
19747 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19748 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19749
19750internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019751 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19752 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19753 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019754
19755internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19756 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19757 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19758
19759internal.htx.size : integer
19760 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19761 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19762
19763internal.htx.used : integer
19764 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19765 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19766 direction.
19767
19768internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19769 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19770 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19771 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19772 of the special value :
19773 * head : The oldest inserted block
19774 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019775 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019776
19777internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19778 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19779 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19780 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19781 integer or one of the special value :
19782 * head : The oldest inserted block
19783 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019784 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019785
19786internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19787 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19788 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19789 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19790 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19791
19792 * head : The oldest inserted block
19793 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019794 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019795
19796internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19797 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19798 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19799 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19800 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19801
19802 * head : The oldest inserted block
19803 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019804 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019805
19806internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19807 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19808 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19809 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19810 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19811
19812 * head : The oldest inserted block
19813 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019814 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019815
19816internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19817 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19818 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19819 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19820 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19821
19822 * head : The oldest inserted block
19823 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019824 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019825
19826internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19827 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19828 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19829 it returns false.
19830
19831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200198327.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019833---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019834
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019835Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19836every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019837order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019838
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019839ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019840---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
19841FALSE always_false never match
19842HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
19843HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
19844HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010019845HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019846HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
19847HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19848HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19849HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19850LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
19851METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
19852METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
19853METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19854METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19855METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19856METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
19857METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
19858METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
19859RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
19860REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
19861TRUE always_true always match
19862WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19863---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019864
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019865
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198668. Logging
19867----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019868
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019869One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19870provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19871very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19872provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19873state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019874to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019875headers.
19876
19877In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19878about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19879send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19880
19881 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19882 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19883 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19884 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19885 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019886 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019887 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019888
19889The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19890allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19891as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19892while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19893real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19894delay.
19895
19896
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198978.1. Log levels
19898---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019899
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019900TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019901source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019902HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19903in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19904track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19905syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19906about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019907
19908
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199098.2. Log formats
19910----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019911
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019912HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019913and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19914slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19915options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019916
19917 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19918 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19919 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19920 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19921 extents.
19922
19923 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19924 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19925 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19926 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19927 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19928
19929 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19930 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19931 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19932 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19933 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19934
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019935 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19936 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19937 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19938 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19939
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019940 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19941
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019942Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19943specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19944field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19945servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19946always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19947identifier.
19948
19949Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19950 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19951 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19952 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19953 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19954
19955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199568.2.1. Default log format
19957-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019958
19959This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19960as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19961format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19962
19963 Example :
19964 listen www
19965 mode http
19966 log global
19967 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19968
19969 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19970 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19971 (www/HTTP)
19972
19973 Field Format Extract from the example above
19974 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19975 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19976 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19977 4 'to' to
19978 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19979 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19980
19981Detailed fields description :
19982 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19983 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19984 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19985 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19986 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19987 and processed the connection.
19988 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19989
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019990In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19991"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19992connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19993
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019994It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19995will eventually disappear.
19996
19997
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199988.2.2. TCP log format
19999---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020000
20001The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20002is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20003information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20004counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20005emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20006environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20007the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20008sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020009specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20010not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20011fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20012marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020013
20014 Example :
20015 frontend fnt
20016 mode tcp
20017 option tcplog
20018 log global
20019 default_backend bck
20020
20021 backend bck
20022 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20023
20024 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20025 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20026 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20027
20028 Field Format Extract from the example above
20029 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20030 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20031 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20032 4 frontend_name fnt
20033 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20034 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20035 7 bytes_read* 212
20036 8 termination_state --
20037 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20038 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20039
20040Detailed fields description :
20041 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020042 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
20043 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20044 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020045 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020046 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020047 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020048
20049 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020050 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20051 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20052 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020053
20054 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
20055 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20056 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020057 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20058 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20059 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20060 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020061
20062 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20063 and processed the connection.
20064
20065 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20066 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20067 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20068 applications.
20069
20070 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20071 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20072 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20073 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20074 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20075
20076 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20077 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20078 See "Timers" below for more details.
20079
20080 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20081 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20082 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20083 "Timers" below for more details.
20084
20085 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020086 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020087 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20088 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20089 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20090 details.
20091
20092 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20093 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20094 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20095 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20096 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20097
20098 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20099 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20100 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20101 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20102 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20103 for more details.
20104
20105 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020106 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020107 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20108 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20109 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020110 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020111
20112 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20113 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20114 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20115 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20116 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20117 caused by a denial of service attack.
20118
20119 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20120 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20121 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20122 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20123 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20124 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20125 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20126 denial of service attack.
20127
20128 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20129 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20130 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20131 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20132 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20133 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20134 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20135 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20136 be processed than on other servers.
20137
20138 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20139 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20140 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20141 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
20142 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
20143 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20144 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20145 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20146 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20147 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20148 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20149 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20150 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20151
20152 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20153 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20154 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20155 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20156 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20157 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020158 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020159 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20160
20161 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20162 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20163 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20164 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20165 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20166 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020167 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020168 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20169 occurs.
20170
20171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201728.2.3. HTTP log format
20173----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020174
20175The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20176is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20177the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20178are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20179emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20180generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20181"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20182which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020183frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20184is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020185
20186Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20187slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20188with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20189
20190 Example :
20191 frontend http-in
20192 mode http
20193 option httplog
20194 log global
20195 default_backend bck
20196
20197 backend static
20198 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20199
20200 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20201 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20202 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020203 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020204
20205 Field Format Extract from the example above
20206 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20207 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020208 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020209 4 frontend_name http-in
20210 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020211 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020212 7 status_code 200
20213 8 bytes_read* 2750
20214 9 captured_request_cookie -
20215 10 captured_response_cookie -
20216 11 termination_state ----
20217 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20218 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20219 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20220 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20221 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020222
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020223Detailed fields description :
20224 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020225 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
20226 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20227 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020228 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020229 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020230 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020231
20232 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020233 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20234 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20235 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020236
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020237 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
20238 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020239
20240 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20241 and processed the connection.
20242
20243 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20244 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20245 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20246
20247 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20248 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20249 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20250 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20251 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20252 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20253
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020254 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20255 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20256 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020257 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020258 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20259 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020260 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
20261 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020262
20263 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20264 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020265 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020266
20267 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20268 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020269 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20270 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020271
20272 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20273 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20274 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20275 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20276 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020277 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20278 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020279
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020280 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
20281 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20282 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20283 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20284 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20285 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20286 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020287 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020288
20289 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
20290 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
20291 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
20292
20293 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20294 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020295 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020296 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20297 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20298 overflowing.
20299
20300 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20301 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20302 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20303 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20304 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20305 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20306 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20307 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20308
20309 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20310 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20311 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20312 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20313 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20314 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20315 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20316 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20317
20318 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20319 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20320 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20321 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20322 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20323 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20324 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20325
20326 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020327 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020328 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20329 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20330 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020331 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020332 system.
20333
20334 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20335 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20336 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20337 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20338 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20339 caused by a denial of service attack.
20340
20341 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20342 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20343 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20344 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20345 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20346 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20347 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20348 denial of service attack.
20349
20350 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20351 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20352 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20353 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20354 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20355 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20356 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20357 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20358 processed than on other servers.
20359
20360 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20361 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20362 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20363 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
20364 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
20365 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20366 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20367 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20368 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20369 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20370 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20371 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20372 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20373
20374 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20375 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20376 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20377 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20378 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20379 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020380 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020381 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20382
20383 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20384 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20385 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20386 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20387 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20388 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020389 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020390 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20391 occurs.
20392
20393 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20394 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20395 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20396 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20397 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20398 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20399 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20400 cookies" below for more details.
20401
20402 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20403 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20404 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20405 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20406 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20407 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20408 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20409 and cookies" below for more details.
20410
20411 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20412 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20413 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20414 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20415 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20416 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20417 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20418 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20419
20420
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200204218.2.4. Custom log format
20422------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020423
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020424The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020425mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020426
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020427HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020428Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20429separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20430prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20431
20432Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20433variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020434("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020435
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020436If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020437as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020438less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20439the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20440
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020441Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20442"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20443delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20444preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020445
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020446Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20447'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20448https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20449such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20450
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020451Flags are :
20452 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020453 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020454 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20455 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020456
20457 Example:
20458
20459 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20460 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20461
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020462 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20463
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020464At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20465
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020466 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20467 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020468
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020469the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020470
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020471 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20472 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20473 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020474
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020475and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20476
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020477 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20478 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020479
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020480Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20481
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020482 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020483 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020484 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20485 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20486 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020487 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20488 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20489 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020490 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020491 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020492 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020493 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020494 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020495 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20496 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020497 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020498 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020499 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020500 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020501 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020502 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020503 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020504 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20505 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20506 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20507 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20508 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020509 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020510 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020511 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020512 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020513 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020514 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20515 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020516 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20517 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20518 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020519 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020520 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20521 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020522 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020523 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20524 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20525 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020526 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020527 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020528 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20529 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20530 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20531 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020532 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020533 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020534 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020535 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020536 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020537 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020538 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20539 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20540 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020541 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020542 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20543 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020544 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020545 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20546 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020547 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020548 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020549 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020550 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020551
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020552 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020553
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020554
205558.2.5. Error log format
20556-----------------------
20557
20558When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
20559protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
20560By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20561"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020562will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020563logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20564
20565The format looks like this :
20566
20567 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20568 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20569 Connection error during SSL handshake
20570
20571 Field Format Extract from the example above
20572 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20573 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20574 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20575 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20576 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20577
20578These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20579failures.
20580
20581
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205828.3. Advanced logging options
20583-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020584
20585Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20586just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20587options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20588for more information about their usage.
20589
20590
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205918.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20592------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020593
20594It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
20595haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
20596commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20597monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20598ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20599
20600 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20601 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20602 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20603 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20604
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020605 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20606 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020607
20608 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20609 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20610 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20611
20612
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206138.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20614----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020615
20616The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20617what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20618or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020619"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020620just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20621log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20622after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20623is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20624with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20625with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20626
20627
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206288.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20629------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020630
20631Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20632for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20633"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20634retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20635raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20636a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20637file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20638you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20639"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20640
20641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206428.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20643--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020644
20645Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20646multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20647them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20648"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20649logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20650error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20651and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20652too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20653useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20654alternative.
20655
20656
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206578.4. Timing events
20658------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020659
20660Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20661reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20662the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20663frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020664mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20665addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20666
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020667Timings events in HTTP mode:
20668
20669 first request 2nd request
20670 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20671 t tr t tr ...
20672 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20673 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20674 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20675 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020676 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020677 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20678
20679Timings events in TCP mode:
20680
20681 TCP session
20682 |<----------------->|
20683 t t
20684 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20685 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20686 |<------ Tt ------->|
20687
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020688 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020689 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020690 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20691 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20692 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020693 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020694 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20695 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20696 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20697 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020698
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020699 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20700 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20701 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020702 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20703 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20704 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20705 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20706 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20707 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020708
20709 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20710 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20711 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20712 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20713 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20714 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20715 request typed by hand during a test.
20716
20717 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20718 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020719 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020720 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20721 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20722 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20723 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020724
20725 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20726 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20727 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20728 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20729 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20730
20731 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20732 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20733 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20734 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20735 connection never established.
20736
20737 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20738 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20739 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20740 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20741 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20742 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20743 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20744 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20745 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20746 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20747 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20748
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020749 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20750 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20751 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20752 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20753 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20754 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20755
20756 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20757
20758 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20759 "Ta" can never be negative.
20760
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020761 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20762 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020763 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20764 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020765 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020766
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020767 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020768
20769 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020770 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20771 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020772
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020773 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20774 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20775 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20776 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20777 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20778 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20779 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20780 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20781
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020782These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20783protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20784that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020785due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20786"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20787that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020788
20789Most common cases :
20790
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020791 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20792 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20793 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20794 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20795 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
20796 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
20797 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20798 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20799 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20800 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20801 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020802 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020803
20804 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20805 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20806 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20807 of ms on remote networks.
20808
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020809 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20810 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20811 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020812
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020813 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20814 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
20815 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
20816 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20817 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20818 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20819 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20820 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20821 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020822
20823Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20824
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020825 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020826 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020827 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020828
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020829 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020830 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20831 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20832
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020833 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020834 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20835 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20836 flags.
20837
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020838 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20839 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020840 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20841 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20842 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20843 the client connection was maintained open.
20844
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020845 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020846 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020847 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020848 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20849
20850
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208518.5. Session state at disconnection
20852-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020853
20854TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20855"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
208562-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20857each of which has a special meaning :
20858
20859 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20860 session to terminate :
20861
20862 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20863
20864 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20865 server explicitly refused it.
20866
20867 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20868 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20869 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20870 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020871 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020872
20873 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20874 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020875
20876 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20877 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20878 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20879 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20880 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20881
20882 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20883 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20884 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20885 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20886 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20887
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020888 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20889 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20890
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020891 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20892 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20893 backup connections when going up.
20894
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020895 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20896
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020897 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20898 send or receive data.
20899
20900 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20901 send or receive data.
20902
20903 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20904 with nothing left in the buffers.
20905
20906 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20907
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020908 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020909 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20910
20911 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20912 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20913 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20914 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20915 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20916
20917 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20918 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20919
20920 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20921 server (HTTP only).
20922
20923 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20924
20925 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20926 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20927 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20928
20929 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20930 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20931 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20932
20933 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20934
20935 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20936 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20937
20938 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20939 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20940 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20941
20942 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20943 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020944 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20945 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020946
20947 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20948 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20949 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20950 another server.
20951
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020952 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020953 server.
20954
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020955 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20956 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20957 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20958 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20959
20960 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20961 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20962 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20963 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20964
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020965 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20966 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20967 "use-server" rule).
20968
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020969 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20970
20971 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20972 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20973
20974 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20975
20976 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20977 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20978 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20979
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020980 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20981 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020982 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020983 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20984 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20985
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020986 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20987
20988 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20989 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20990
20991 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20992
20993 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20994
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020995The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20996was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020997helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20998starvation, attacks, etc...
20999
21000The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21001alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21002easier finding and understanding.
21003
21004 Flags Reason
21005
21006 -- Normal termination.
21007
21008 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
21009 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
21010 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
21011 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21012
21013 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21014 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
21015 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21016 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
21017 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21018 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021019
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021020 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21021 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021022 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021023
21024 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21025 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21026 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21027
21028 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21029 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21030 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21031 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21032 the server takes too long to respond.
21033
21034 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21035 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21036 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21037 long a time to respond.
21038
21039 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21040 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21041 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
21042 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021043 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21044 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021045
21046 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21047 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21048 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21049 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21050 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021051 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021052 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21053 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21054 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21055 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21056 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21057 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21058 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21059 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021060 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021061 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21062 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21063 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021064
21065 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21066 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021067 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21068 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21069 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21070 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021071
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021072 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
21073 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21074
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021075 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021076 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21077 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021078 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021079 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21080 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21081
21082 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21083 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21084 503 or 504 here.
21085
21086 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
21087 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
21088 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21089 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21090 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21091
21092 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21093 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021094 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021095 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
21096 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
21097
21098 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21099 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21100 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21101 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21102 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21103 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
21104 between haproxy and the server.
21105
21106 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21107 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21108 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21109 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21110 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21111 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21112 solution is to fix the application.
21113
21114 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21115 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21116 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21117 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21118 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21119 external attacks.
21120
21121 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021122 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021123 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021124 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21125 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21126
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021127 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21128 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21129 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021130 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021131 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021132
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021133 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21134 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21135 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21136 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021137 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21138 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21139 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21140 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
21141 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021142
21143 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21144 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21145 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
21146 returned an HTTP 403 error.
21147
21148 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21149 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21150 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21151 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21152
21153 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21154 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21155 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21156 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21157
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021158The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
21159persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
21160important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21161re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21162
21163 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21164
21165 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21166 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21167 set on a GET request.
21168
21169 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21170 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021171 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021172 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21173
21174 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21175 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21176 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21177
21178 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21179 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21180 already got a cookie.
21181
21182 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21183 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21184 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21185 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21186 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21187
21188 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21189 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21190 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21191
21192 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21193 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21194 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21195
21196 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21197 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21198
21199 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21200 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21201 then advertised in the response.
21202
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021203
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212048.6. Non-printable characters
21205-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021206
21207In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21208consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21209converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21210prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21211being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21212escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21213is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21214'}' when logging headers.
21215
21216Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21217issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21218containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21219
21220Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21221the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21222performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21223
21224
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212258.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21226---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021227
21228Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21229achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021230section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021231cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21232the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21233the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021234locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021235not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21236user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21237a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21238wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21239
21240 Examples :
21241 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21242 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21243
21244 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21245 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21246
21247
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212488.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21249---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021250
21251Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21252proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21253the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21254server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21255
21256Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21257response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021258section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021259
21260It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021261time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21262appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021263are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21264and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21265follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21266request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21267in the logs.
21268
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021269As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21270frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21271an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21272
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021273 Example :
21274 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21275 listen proxy-out
21276 mode http
21277 option httplog
21278 option logasap
21279 log global
21280 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21281
21282 # log the name of the virtual server
21283 capture request header Host len 20
21284
21285 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21286 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21287
21288 # log the beginning of the referrer
21289 capture request header Referer len 20
21290
21291 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21292 capture response header Server len 20
21293
21294 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21295 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21296
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021297 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021298 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21299
21300 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21301 capture response header Via len 20
21302
21303 # log the URL location during a redirection
21304 capture response header Location len 20
21305
21306 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21307 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21308 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21309 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21310 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21311
21312 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21313 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21314 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21315 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021316 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021317
21318 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21319 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21320 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21321 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21322 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021323 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021324
21325
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213268.9. Examples of logs
21327---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021328
21329These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21330them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21331reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21332
21333 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21334 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21335 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21336
21337 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21338 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21339
21340 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21341 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21342 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21343
21344 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21345 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21346
21347 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21348 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21349 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21350
21351 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021352 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021353 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21354 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21355
21356 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21357 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21358 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21359
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021360 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21361 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21362 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21363 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
21364 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
21365 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021366
21367 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021368 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021369
21370 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21371 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21372 Nothing was sent to any server.
21373
21374 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21375 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21376
21377 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21378 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021379 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021380 send a 408 return code to the client.
21381
21382 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21383 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21384
21385 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21386 5 seconds ("c----").
21387
21388 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21389 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021390 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021391
21392 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021393 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021394 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21395 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21396 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21397 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21398 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021399
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021400
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200214019. Supported filters
21402--------------------
21403
21404Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21405accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21406unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21407
21408See also : "filter"
21409
214109.1. Trace
21411----------
21412
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021413filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021414
21415 Arguments:
21416 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21417 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21418
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021419 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021420
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021421 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021422 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21423 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21424 amount of the parsed data.
21425
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021426 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021427
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021428This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21429callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21430information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21431filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21432
21433Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21434tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21435a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21436
21437
214389.2. HTTP compression
21439---------------------
21440
21441filter compression
21442
21443The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21444keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021445when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21446fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21447done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21448explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21449filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21450listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21451order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021452
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021453See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21454 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021455
21456
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200214579.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21458--------------------------------------------
21459
21460filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21461
21462 Arguments :
21463
21464 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21465 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21466 parsed.
21467
21468 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21469 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21470 part must be placed in its own scope.
21471
21472The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21473external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021474streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021475exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21476also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21477
21478SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21479the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21480
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021481For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021482"doc/SPOE.txt".
21483
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100214849.4. Cache
21485----------
21486
21487filter cache <name>
21488
21489 Arguments :
21490
21491 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21492
21493The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21494"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021495cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021496other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21497case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21498is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21499filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021500listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21501order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021502
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021503See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21504 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21505
21506
215079.5. Fcgi-app
21508-------------
21509
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021510filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021511
21512 Arguments :
21513
21514 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21515
21516The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21517request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21518reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21519used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21520implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21521used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21522fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21523used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21524order.
21525
21526See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21527 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21528
21529
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100215309.6. OpenTracing
21531----------------
21532
21533The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21534HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21535of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21536Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21537
21538This feature is only enabled when haproxy was built with USE_OT=1.
21539
21540The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21541HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21542participates in the work of HAProxy.
21543
21544filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21545
21546 Arguments :
21547
21548 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21549 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21550 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21551 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21552 OpenTracing filters.
21553
21554 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21555 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21556 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21557 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21558 filter must have its own scope defined.
21559
21560More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021561of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021562
21563
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002156410. FastCGI applications
21565-------------------------
21566
21567HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21568feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21569the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21570FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21571servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21572FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21573backend.
21574
21575HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21576application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21577connection.
21578
2157910.1. Setup
21580-----------
21581
2158210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21583--------------------------
21584
21585fcgi-app <name>
21586 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21587 document root must be defined.
21588
21589acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21590 Declare or complete an access list.
21591
21592 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21593 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21594 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21595 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21596 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21597
21598docroot <path>
21599 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21600 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21601 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21602
21603index <script-name>
21604 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21605 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21606 is an optional setting.
21607
21608 Example :
21609 index index.php
21610
21611log-stderr global
21612log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021613 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021614 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21615
21616 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21617 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21618
21619pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21620 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21621 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21622 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21623
21624 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21625 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21626 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21627 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21628
21629 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21630 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21631
21632path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021633 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021634 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21635 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21636 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21637 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21638 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21639 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21640 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021641
21642 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021643 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021644 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21645 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21646 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21647 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021648
21649 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021650 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21651 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021652
21653option get-values
21654no option get-values
21655 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21656
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021657 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021658 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21659
21660 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21661 application will accept.
21662
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021663 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21664 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021665
21666 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021667 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021668 option is disabled.
21669
21670 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21671 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21672 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21673 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21674 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21675 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21676
21677option keep-conn
21678no option keep-conn
21679 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21680 sending a response.
21681
21682 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21683 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21684
21685option max-reqs <reqs>
21686 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21687 accept.
21688
21689 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21690 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21691 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21692 to 1.
21693
21694option mpxs-conns
21695no option mpxs-conns
21696 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21697
21698 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21699 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21700
21701set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21702 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21703 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21704 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21705 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21706
21707 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21708 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21709 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21710
21711 Example :
21712 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21713 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21714
21715 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21716
21717
2171810.1.2. Proxy section
21719---------------------
21720
21721use-fcgi-app <name>
21722 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21723
21724 Arguments :
21725 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21726
21727 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21728 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21729 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21730 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21731 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21732
21733 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21734 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21735 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21736 application are evaluated.
21737
21738
2173910.1.3. Example
21740---------------
21741
21742 frontend front-http
21743 mode http
21744 bind *:80
21745 bind *:
21746
21747 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21748 default_backend back-static
21749
21750 backend back-static
21751 mode http
21752 server www A.B.C.D:80
21753
21754 backend back-dynamic
21755 mode http
21756 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21757 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21758
21759 fcgi-app php-fpm
21760 log-stderr global
21761 option keep-conn
21762
21763 docroot /var/www/my-app
21764 index index.php
21765 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21766
21767
2176810.2. Default parameters
21769------------------------
21770
21771A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21772the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021773script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021774applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21775
21776 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21777 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21778 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21779 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21780 | | |
21781 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21782 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21783 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21784 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21785 | | application. |
21786 | | |
21787 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21788 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21789 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21790 | | |
21791 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21792 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21793 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21794 | | the application's configuration. |
21795 | | |
21796 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21797 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21798 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21799 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21800 | | |
21801 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21802 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21803 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21804 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21805 | | be defined. |
21806 | | |
21807 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21808 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21809 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21810 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21811 | | is not set too. |
21812 | | |
21813 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21814 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21815 | | set. |
21816 | | |
21817 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21818 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21819 | | the request. |
21820 | | |
21821 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21822 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21823 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21824 | | |
21825 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21826 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21827 | | script to process the request. |
21828 | | |
21829 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21830 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21831 | | |
21832 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21833 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21834 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21835 | | |
21836 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21837 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21838 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21839 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21840 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21841 | | |
21842 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21843 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21844 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21845 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21846 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21847 | | side. |
21848 | | |
21849 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21850 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21851 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21852 | | connected to. |
21853 | | |
21854 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21855 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21856 | | |
21857 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21858 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
21859 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
21860 | | |
21861 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21862
21863
2186410.3. Limitations
21865------------------
21866
21867The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21868way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21869during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21870establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21871application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21872or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21873message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21874these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21875and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21876
21877Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21878request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21879requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21880
21881About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21882into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21883fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21884"http-request" ones.
21885
21886Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21887FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21888processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21889must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21890here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021891
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020021892
2189311. Address formats
21894-------------------
21895
21896Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
21897address.
21898
21899This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
21900The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
21901of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
21902equivalent is '::'.
21903
21904Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
21905is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
21906
21907This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
21908family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
21909
21910Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
21911configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
21912use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
21913'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
21914
21915Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
21916socket type and the transport method.
21917
21918
2191911.1 Address family prefixes
21920----------------------------
21921
21922'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
21923
21924'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
21925 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
21926 listening.
21927
21928'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
21929 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
21930 on the statement using this address, a port or
21931 a port range may or must be specified.
21932
21933'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21934 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
21935 using this address, a port or a port range
21936 may or must be specified.
21937
21938'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21939 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
21940 using this address, a port or a port range
21941 may or must be specified.
21942
21943'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
21944 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
21945 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
21946 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
21947 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
21948 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
21949
21950'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
21951 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
21952 start by slash '/'.
21953
21954
2195511.2 Socket type prefixes
21956-------------------------
21957
21958Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
21959type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
21960this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
21961This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
21962but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
21963
21964Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
21965instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
21966
21967If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
21968they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
21969report this to the maintainers.
21970
21971'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21972 to "stream"
21973
21974'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21975 to "datagram".
21976
21977
2197811.3 Protocol prefixes
21979----------------------
21980
21981'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21982 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21983 socket type and transport method is forced to
21984 "stream". Depending on the statement using
21985 this address, a port or a port range can or
21986 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21987 of 'stream+ip@'.
21988
21989'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21990 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21991 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21992 statement using this address, a port or port
21993 range can or must be specified.
21994 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21995
21996'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21997 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
21998 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21999 statement using this address, a port or port
22000 range can or must be specified.
22001 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22002
22003'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22004 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22005 socket type and transport method is forced to
22006 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22007 this address, a port or a port range can or
22008 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22009 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22010
22011'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22012 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22013 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22014 the statement using this address, a port or
22015 port range can or must be specified.
22016 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22017
22018'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22019 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22020 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22021 the statement using this address, a port or
22022 port range can or must be specified.
22023 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22024
22025'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22026 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22027 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22028
22029'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22030 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22031 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22032
22033In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22034QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22035
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022036/*
22037 * Local variables:
22038 * fill-column: 79
22039 * End:
22040 */